tm.texi revision 102780
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,2002
2@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3@c This is part of the GCC manual.
4@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6@node Target Macros
7@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8@cindex machine description macros
9@cindex target description macros
10@cindex macros, target description
11@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18@file{.md} file.  The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19@file{@var{machine}.h}.  The header file @file{config.h} includes
20@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}.  The
21source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23machine.  @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27@menu
28* Target Structure::    The @code{targetm} variable.
29* Driver::              Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30* Run-time Target::     Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31* Per-Function Data::   Defining data structures for per-function information.
32* Storage Layout::      Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33* Type Layout::         Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34* Escape Sequences::    Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35* Registers::           Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes::    Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Stack and Calling::   Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38* Varargs::		Defining the varargs macros.
39* Trampolines::         Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40* Library Calls::       Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41* Addressing Modes::    Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42* Condition Code::      Defining how insns update the condition code.
43* Costs::               Defining relative costs of different operations.
44* Scheduling::          Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45* Sections::            Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46* PIC::			Macros for position independent code.
47* Assembler Format::    Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48* Debugging Info::      Defining the format of debugging output.
49* Cross-compilation::   Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50* Mode Switching::      Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51* Target Attributes::   Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52* Misc::                Everything else.
53@end menu
54
55@node Target Structure
56@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
57@cindex target hooks
58@cindex target functions
59
60@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
61The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
62which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
63machine.  The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
64@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
65used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
66for elements of the structure.  The @file{.c} file should override those
67macros for which the default definition is inappropriate.  For example:
68@smallexample
69#include "target.h"
70#include "target-def.h"
71
72/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.}  */
73
74#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
75#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
76
77struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
78@end smallexample
79@end deftypevar
80
81Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
82form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
83``Target Hook'' with a prototype.  Many macros will change in future
84from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
85@code{targetm} structure.
86
87@node Driver
88@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
89@cindex driver
90@cindex controlling the compilation driver
91
92@c prevent bad page break with this line
93You can control the compilation driver.
94
95@table @code
96@findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
97@item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
98A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
99takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
100option takes--zero, for many options.
101
102By default, this macro is defined as
103@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
104properly.  You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
105wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
106should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
107additional options.
108
109@findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
110@item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
111A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
112takes arguments.  The value should be the number of arguments that
113option takes--zero, for many options.  This macro rather than
114@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
115
116By default, this macro is defined as
117@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
118properly.  You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
119wish to add additional options which take arguments.  Any redefinition
120should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
121additional options.
122
123@findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
124@item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
125A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
126stops compilation before the generation of an executable.  The value is
127boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
128generated, zero otherwise.
129
130By default, this macro is defined as
131@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
132options properly.  You need not define
133@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
134options which affect the generation of an executable.  Any redefinition
135should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
136for additional options.
137
138@findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
139@item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
141the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
142
143If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
144
145@findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
146@item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
148potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
149second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
150supported) list of options with which to replace the first option.  The
151target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
152are valid.  Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
153must be the @code{-opt} style.  It is the intention of this macro to
154provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
155such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
156multilibs.  Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
157@code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
158
159@example
160#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
161@{ "-fast",   "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
162@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
163@end example
164
165@findex CPP_SPEC
166@item CPP_SPEC
167A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
168pass to CPP@.  It can also specify how to translate options you
169give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
170
171Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
172
173@findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
174@item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
175This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
176than C@.  If you do not define this macro, then the value of
177@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
178
179@findex NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
180@item NO_BUILTIN_SIZE_TYPE
181If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
182@code{__SIZE_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__SIZE_TYPE__} must then be defined
183by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
184
185This should be defined if @code{SIZE_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
186which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
187be defined.
188
189@findex NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
190@item NO_BUILTIN_PTRDIFF_TYPE
191If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
192@code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__PTRDIFF_TYPE__} must then be
193defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
194
195This should be defined if @code{PTRDIFF_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
196which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
197be defined.
198
199@findex NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
200@item NO_BUILTIN_WCHAR_TYPE
201If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
202@code{__WCHAR_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WCHAR_TYPE__} must then be
203defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
204
205This should be defined if @code{WCHAR_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
206which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
207be defined.
208
209@findex NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
210@item NO_BUILTIN_WINT_TYPE
211If this macro is defined, the preprocessor will not define the built-in macro
212@code{__WINT_TYPE__}.  The macro @code{__WINT_TYPE__} must then be
213defined by @code{CPP_SPEC} instead.
214
215This should be defined if @code{WINT_TYPE} depends on target dependent flags
216which are not accessible to the preprocessor.  Otherwise, it should not
217be defined.
218
219@findex CC1_SPEC
220@item CC1_SPEC
221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
223front ends.
224It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
225for GCC to pass to front ends.
226
227Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
228
229@findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
230@item CC1PLUS_SPEC
231A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
232pass to @code{cc1plus}.  It can also specify how to translate options you
233give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
234
235Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
237@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
238CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
239
240@findex ASM_SPEC
241@item ASM_SPEC
242A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
243pass to the assembler.  It can also specify how to translate options
244you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
245See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
246
247Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
248
249@findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
250@item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
251A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
252run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
253Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{mips.h} for
254an example of this.
255
256Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
257
258@findex LINK_SPEC
259@item LINK_SPEC
260A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
261pass to the linker.  It can also specify how to translate options you
262give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
263
264Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
265
266@findex LIB_SPEC
267@item LIB_SPEC
268Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The difference
269between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
270command given to the linker.
271
272If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
273loads the standard C library from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
274
275@findex LIBGCC_SPEC
276@item LIBGCC_SPEC
277Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
278how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
279linker command line.  This constant is placed both before and after
280the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
281
282If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
283passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
284
285@findex STARTFILE_SPEC
286@item STARTFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
288difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
290
291If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
292standard C startup file from the usual place.  See @file{gcc.c}.
293
294@findex ENDFILE_SPEC
295@item ENDFILE_SPEC
296Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}.  The
297difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
298the very end of the command given to the linker.
299
300Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
301
302@findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
303@item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
304GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
305However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
306models, such as AIX 4.3.  On such platforms, define
307@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
308blanks that names one of the recognized thread models.  @code{%*}, the
309default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
310@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
311
312@findex EXTRA_SPECS
313@item EXTRA_SPECS
314Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
315@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
316@code{CC1_SPEC}.
317
318The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
319containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
320string constant that provides the specification.
321
322Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
323
324@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
325related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
326to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
327these definitions.
328
329For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
330define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
331used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
332used.
333
334The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
335
336@example
337#define EXTRA_SPECS \
338  @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
339
340#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
341@end example
342
343The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
344@smallexample
345#undef CPP_SPEC
346#define CPP_SPEC \
347"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
348%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
349%@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
350%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
351
352#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
353#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
354@end smallexample
355
356while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
357@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
358
359@smallexample
360#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
361#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
362@end smallexample
363
364@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
365@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
366Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
367@file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
368linker.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
369the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
370pass @option{-L} options to it.
371
372@findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
373@item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
374Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
375@file{libgcc.a}.  If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
376the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
377This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
378not affect @option{-L} options.
379
380@findex LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
381@item LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
382The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
383By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
384
385@findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
386@item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
387A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
388linker.  When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
389change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}.  Therefore,
390define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
391line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
392the effect you need.  Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
393@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
394
395@findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
396@item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
397A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
398directories from linking commands.  Do not give it a nonzero value if
399removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
400
401@findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
402@item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
403Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
404string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
405target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
406@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
407
408Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
409the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
410@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
411@xref{Target Fragment}.
412
413@findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
414@item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
415Define this macro to tell @code{gcc} that it should only translate
416a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
417indicates an absolute file name.
418
419@findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
420@item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
423try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
424
425@findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
426@item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
427If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
428@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
429when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
430compiler.  If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
431to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
432
433@findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
434@item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
437try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438
439@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
440@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
441If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
442standard prefixes.  @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
443@option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
444compiler.
445
446@findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
447@item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
448If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
449standard prefixes.  It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
450used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451
452@findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
453@item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
454Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
455variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
456loader.  The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
457initialize the necessary environment variables.
458
459@findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
460@item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
461Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
462standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
463try when searching for local header files.  @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
464comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
465
466Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
467replacement.
468
469@findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
470@item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
471Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
472default target name
473
474For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
475part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
476configuration name, if present.  The definition should be an initializer
477for an array of structures.  Each array element should have three
478elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
479dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
480indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
481to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
482
483For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
484configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
485and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
486code
487
488@smallexample
489#define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
490  @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
491     @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
492@end smallexample
493
494
495@findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
496@item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
497Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
498system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
499directory.  @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
500@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
501
502Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
503specified.
504
505@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
506@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
507Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
508standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
509try when searching for header files.
510
511Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
512@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
513
514@findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
515@item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
516The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
517See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
518If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
519
520@findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
521@item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
522Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
523for include files.  For a native compiler, the default search path
524usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
525@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
526@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.  In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
527and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
528and specify private search areas for GCC@.  The directory
529@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
530
531The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
532Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
533string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
534for C++-only directories,
535and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
536wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++.  Mark the end of
537the array with a null element.
538
539The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
540if any, in all upper-case letters.  For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
541or @samp{BINUTILS}.  If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
542operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
543
544For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
545
546@example
547#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
548@{                                       \
549  @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@},   \
550  @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@},    \
551  @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@},  \
552  @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@},                      \
553  @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@}                         \
554@}
555@end example
556@end table
557
558Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
559
560@enumerate
561@item
562Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563
564@item
565The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
566
567@item
568The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
569
570@item
571The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
572
573@item
574@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
575
576@item
577The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
578@end enumerate
579
580Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
581
582@enumerate
583@item
584Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
585
586@item
587The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
588
589@item
590The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
591(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
592
593@item
594The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
595
596@item
597@file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
598
599@item
600The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
601
602@item
603The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
604
605@item
606The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
607
608@item
609@file{/lib/}.
610
611@item
612@file{/usr/lib/}.
613@end enumerate
614
615@node Run-time Target
616@section Run-time Target Specification
617@cindex run-time target specification
618@cindex predefined macros
619@cindex target specifications
620
621@c prevent bad page break with this line
622Here are run-time target specifications.
623
624@table @code
625@findex CPP_PREDEFINES
626@item CPP_PREDEFINES
627Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
628define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
629These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
630@option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
631
632In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
633made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end.  These
634@samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
635predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
636is specified.
637
638For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
639
640@smallexample
641"-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
642@end smallexample
643
644The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
645and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
646@code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
647
648@findex extern int target_flags
649@item extern int target_flags;
650This declaration should be present.
651
652@cindex optional hardware or system features
653@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
654@item TARGET_@dots{}
655This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
656enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
657For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
658the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
659use 68020-only instructions or not.  This command argument works
660by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
661@code{target_flags}.
662
663Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
664Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}.  It is
665recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
666is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
667@code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}.  For
668example:
669
670@smallexample
671#define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
672#define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
673@end smallexample
674
675One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
676of instruction patterns.  Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
677frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
678Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
679macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
680
681@findex TARGET_SWITCHES
682@item TARGET_SWITCHES
683This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
684bits in @code{target_flags}.  Its definition is an initializer
685with a subgrouping for each command option.
686
687Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
688name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
689@code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
690displayed by @option{--help}.  If the number is negative then the bits specified
691by the number are cleared instead of being set.  If the description
692string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
693for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option.  The
694actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
695Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
696@command{xgettext}.  Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
697string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
698of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
699
700In addition to the description for @option{--help},
701more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
702@file{invoke.texi}.
703
704One of the subgroupings should have a null string.  The number in
705this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}.  Any
706target options act starting with that value.
707
708Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
709with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
710
711@smallexample
712#define TARGET_SWITCHES \
713  @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @},      \
714    @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
715      N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
716    @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
717@end smallexample
718
719@findex TARGET_OPTIONS
720@item TARGET_OPTIONS
721This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
722options that have values.  Its definition is an initializer with a
723subgrouping for each command option.
724
725Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
726of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
727Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
728@command{xgettext}.  Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
729string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
730of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
731
732The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
733given option if the fixed part matches.  The actual option name is made
734by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.  Again, each option should
735also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
736
737Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}.  If the
738given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
739will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
740
741@smallexample
742extern char *m88k_short_data;
743#define TARGET_OPTIONS \
744 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
745     N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
746@end smallexample
747
748@findex TARGET_VERSION
749@item TARGET_VERSION
750This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
751describing the particular machine description choice.  Every machine
752description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}.  For example:
753
754@smallexample
755#ifdef MOTOROLA
756#define TARGET_VERSION \
757  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
758#else
759#define TARGET_VERSION \
760  fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
761#endif
762@end smallexample
763
764@findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
765@item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
766Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
767a particular target machine.  You can define a macro
768@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this.  This macro, if
769defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
770parsed.
771
772Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
773@option{-O}.  That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
774
775@findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
776@item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
777Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
778various optimization levels.   This macro, if defined, is executed once
779just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
780of the command options have been parsed.  Values set in this macro are
781used as the default values for the other command line options.
782
783@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
784specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
785
786@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
787
788You should not use this macro to change options that are not
789machine-specific.  These should uniformly selected by the same
790optimization level on all supported machines.  Use this macro to enable
791machine-specific optimizations.
792
793@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
794this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
795generated code.
796
797@findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
798@item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
799Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
800pointer.  If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
801@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
802@end table
803
804@node Per-Function Data
805@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
806@cindex per-function data
807@cindex data structures
808
809If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
810provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this.  Note, just
811using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
812nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
813when another one comes along.
814
815GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
816contains all of the data specific to an individual function.  This
817structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
818@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
819to their own specific data.
820
821If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
822@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro
823@code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.  This macro should be used to initialize some or
824all of the function pointers @code{init_machine_status},
825@code{free_machine_status} and @code{mark_machine_status}.  These
826pointers are explained below.
827
828One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
829RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address.  This
830RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
831function, for level 0.
832
833Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
834all of the per-function information.  Thus when processing of a nested
835function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
836stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
837stack.  GCC used to provide function pointers called
838@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
839the saving and restoring of the target specific information.  Since the
840single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
841longer supported.
842
843The macro and function pointers are described below.
844
845@table @code
846@findex INIT_EXPANDERS
847@item   INIT_EXPANDERS
848Macro called to initialize any target specific information.  This macro
849is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
850The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
851function pointers below.
852
853@findex init_machine_status
854@item   init_machine_status
855This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
856pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
857compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
858specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure.  It is
859intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
860that structure.
861
862@findex free_machine_status
863@item   free_machine_status
864This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
865pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, after the
866function has been compiled, in order to allow any memory allocated
867during the @code{init_machine_status} function call to be freed.
868
869@findex mark_machine_status
870@item   mark_machine_status
871This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer.  If this
872pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function in order to mark
873any data items in the @code{struct machine_function} structure which
874need garbage collection.
875
876@end table
877
878@node Storage Layout
879@section Storage Layout
880@cindex storage layout
881
882Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
883alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant.  They can be C
884expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
885@xref{Run-time Target}.
886
887@table @code
888@findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
889@item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
890Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
891byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
892This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
893bit.  If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
894be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to.  This
895macro need not be a constant.
896
897This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
898bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
899
900@findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
901@item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
902Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
903word has the lowest number.  This macro need not be a constant.
904
905@findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
906@item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
907Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
908most significant word has the lowest number.  This applies to both
909memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
910order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers.  This
911macro need not be a constant.
912
913@findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
914@item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
915Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant.  This must be a
916constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
917used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}.  Typically the value will be set
918based on preprocessor defines.
919
920@findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
921@item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
922Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
923@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
924containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
925have the value 0.  This macro need not be a constant.
926
927You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
928multi-word integers.
929
930@findex BITS_PER_UNIT
931@item BITS_PER_UNIT
932Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
933unit (byte); normally 8.
934
935@findex BITS_PER_WORD
936@item BITS_PER_WORD
937Number of bits in a word; normally 32.
938
939@findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
940@item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
941Maximum number of bits in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
942@code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
943largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
944
945@findex UNITS_PER_WORD
946@item UNITS_PER_WORD
947Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
948
949@findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
950@item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
951Minimum number of units in a word.  If this is undefined, the default is
952@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
953smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
954
955@findex POINTER_SIZE
956@item POINTER_SIZE
957Width of a pointer, in bits.  You must specify a value no wider than the
958width of @code{Pmode}.  If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
959you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}.
960
961@findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
962@item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
963A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
964extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
965be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended.  If the value
966is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
967extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
968
969You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
970to the width of @code{Pmode}.
971
972@findex PROMOTE_MODE
973@item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
974A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
975is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
976stored in a register.  This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
977scalar type.
978
979On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
980register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
981@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.  In most
982cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
983floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
984counterparts.
985
986For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
987However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
988either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes.  For example, on
989the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
990sign-extend the result to 64 bits.  On such machines, set
991@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
992
993Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
994
995@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
996@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
997Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
998should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
999
1000@findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1001@item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1002Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1003should also be done for the return value of functions.
1004
1005If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1006promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1007
1008@findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1009@item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1010Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1011should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1012function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1013and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1014
1015@findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1016@item PARM_BOUNDARY
1017Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1018bits.  All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1019regardless of data type.  On most machines, this is the same as the
1020size of an integer.
1021
1022@findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1023@item STACK_BOUNDARY
1024Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1025stack pointer on this machine.  The definition is a C expression for the
1026desired alignment (measured in bits).  This value is used as a default
1027if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined.  On most machines,
1028this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1029
1030@findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1031@item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1032Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1033stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces.  The definition
1034is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits).  This
1035macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1036@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1037
1038@findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1039@item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1040A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1041not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1042at the beginning of @code{main}.
1043
1044@cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1045If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1046to the specified boundary.  If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1047a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1048be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1049
1050@findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1051@item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1052Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1053
1054@findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1055@item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1056Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1057
1058@findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1059@item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1060If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1061object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1062nearby object.  Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1063on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1064
1065@findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1066@item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1067Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1068machine, in bits.  If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1069structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1070by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1071
1072@findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1073@item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1074An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1075alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1076@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1077alignment) is @var{computed}.  It overrides alignment only if the
1078field alignment has not been set by the
1079@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1080
1081@findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1082@item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1083Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1084Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1085@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.  If not defined,
1086the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1087
1088@findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1089@item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1090If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1091the static store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1092the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1093macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1094
1095If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1096
1097@findex strcpy
1098One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1099make it all fit in fewer cache lines.  Another is to cause character
1100arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1101constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1102
1103@findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1104@item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1105If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1106that is being placed in memory.  @var{constant} is the constant and
1107@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1108have.  The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1109align the object.
1110
1111If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1112
1113The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1114constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1115constants can be done inline.
1116
1117@findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1118@item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1119If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1120the local store.  @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1121the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.  The value of this
1122macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1123
1124If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1125
1126One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1127make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1128
1129@findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1130@item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1131Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1132empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1133
1134Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1135that results from an empty field.
1136
1137@findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1138@item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1139Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1140Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1141
1142If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1143@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1144
1145@findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1146@item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1147Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1148if given data not on the nominal alignment.  If instructions will merely
1149go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1150
1151@findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1152@item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1153Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1154alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1155
1156The behavior is that the type written for a bit-field (@code{int},
1157@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the
1158entire structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary
1159field of that type.  In addition, the bit-field is placed within the
1160structure so that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a
1161boundary for it.
1162
1163Thus, on most machines, a bit-field whose type is written as @code{int}
1164would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force four-byte
1165alignment for the whole structure.  (The alignment used may not be four
1166bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1167
1168If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1169a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1170
1171Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1172bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary.  The compiler can
1173support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1174@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1175
1176The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1177@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1178Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1179
1180Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1181@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1182@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1183
1184If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1185bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1186what the other compiler does.  Compile and run this program:
1187
1188@example
1189struct foo1
1190@{
1191  char x;
1192  char :0;
1193  char y;
1194@};
1195
1196struct foo2
1197@{
1198  char x;
1199  int :0;
1200  char y;
1201@};
1202
1203main ()
1204@{
1205  printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1206          sizeof (struct foo1));
1207  printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1208          sizeof (struct foo2));
1209  exit (0);
1210@}
1211@end example
1212
1213If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1214get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1215
1216@findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1217@item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1218Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1219to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1220
1221@findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1222@item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field})
1223Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1224@code{BLKMODE}.
1225
1226Normally, this is not needed.  See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1227of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1228field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1229
1230@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1231@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1232Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1233(given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1234usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1235
1236The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1237
1238@findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1239@item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1240Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1241specified in units (bytes).  If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1242you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1243with each other.
1244
1245@findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1246@item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1247Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1248by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1249way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1250@var{specified}.
1251
1252The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1253the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1254
1255@findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1256@item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1257An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1258machine mode that should actually be used.  All integer machine modes of
1259this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1260appropriate sizes.  If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1261(DImode)} is assumed.
1262
1263@findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1264@item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1265Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1266involving vector mode @var{mode}.  At the very least, it must have move
1267patterns for this mode.
1268
1269@findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1270@item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1271If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1272specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1273@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1274@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1275@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1276having its mode specified.
1277
1278You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}.  You
1279would most commonly define this macro if the
1280@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128164-bit mode.
1282
1283@findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1284@item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1285If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1286specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1287@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1288
1289You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1290You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1291pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1292
1293@findex CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE
1294@item CHECK_FLOAT_VALUE (@var{mode}, @var{value}, @var{overflow})
1295A C statement to validate the value @var{value} (of type
1296@code{double}) for mode @var{mode}.  This means that you check whether
1297@var{value} fits within the possible range of values for mode
1298@var{mode} on this target machine.  The mode @var{mode} is always
1299a mode of class @code{MODE_FLOAT}.  @var{overflow} is nonzero if
1300the value is already known to be out of range.
1301
1302If @var{value} is not valid or if @var{overflow} is nonzero, you should
1303set @var{overflow} to 1 and then assign some valid value to @var{value}.
1304Allowing an invalid value to go through the compiler can produce
1305incorrect assembler code which may even cause Unix assemblers to crash.
1306
1307This macro need not be defined if there is no work for it to do.
1308
1309@findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1310@item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1311A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1312There are five defined values:
1313
1314@table @code
1315@findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1316@item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1317This code indicates IEEE floating point.  It is the default; there is no
1318need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1319
1320@findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1321@item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1322This code indicates the ``D float'' format used on the VAX@.
1323
1324@findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1325@item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1326This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1327
1328@findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1329@item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1330This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1331
1332@findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1333@item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1334This code indicates any other format.
1335@end table
1336
1337The value of this macro is compared with @code{HOST_FLOAT_FORMAT}, which
1338is defined by the @command{configure} script, to determine whether the
1339target machine has the same format as the host machine.  If any other
1340formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1341defined for them.
1342
1343The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1344memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1345
1346@end table
1347
1348@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1349This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1350@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1351Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1352unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1353different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1354alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1355bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1356the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1357(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1358another bit-field of non-zero size.  If this hook returns @code{true},
1359other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1360@end deftypefn
1361
1362@node Type Layout
1363@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1364
1365These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1366basic data types used in programs being compiled.  Unlike the macros in
1367the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1368languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1369
1370@table @code
1371@findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1372@item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1373A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1374target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1375
1376@findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1377@item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1378A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1379target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1380(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1381unit.)
1382
1383@findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1384@item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1385A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1386target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1387
1388@findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1389@item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1390On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1391@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C.  In
1392that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1393the size of that type.  If you don't define this, the default is the
1394value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1395
1396@findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1397@item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1398Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1399target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1400@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1401largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1402used in @code{cpp}.
1403
1404@findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1405@item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1406A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1407target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1408words.  If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1409macro must be at least 64.
1410
1411@findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1412@item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1413A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1414target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is
1415@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1416
1417@findex MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1418@item MAX_CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1419Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1420target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1421@code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1422largest value that @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1423used in @code{cpp}.
1424
1425@findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1426@item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1427A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1428C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine.  If you don't define
1429this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1430
1431@findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1432@item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1433A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1434target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1435
1436@findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1437@item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1438A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1439target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1440words.
1441
1442@findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1443@item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1444A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1445the target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is two
1446words.
1447
1448@findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1449Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1450target machine.  If this is undefined, the default is
1451@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1452the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1453This is used in @code{cpp}.
1454
1455@findex INTEL_EXTENDED_IEEE_FORMAT
1456Define this macro to be 1 if the target machine uses 80-bit floating-point
1457values with 128-bit size and alignment.  This is used in @file{real.c}.
1458
1459@findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1460@item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1461A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1462supported by the hardware.  If you define this macro, you must specify a
1463value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1464If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1465is the default.
1466
1467@findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1468@item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1469An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1470@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default.  The user can
1471always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1472and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1473
1474@findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1475@item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1476A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1477only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1478of that type.  A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1479@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1480
1481If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1482
1483@findex SIZE_TYPE
1484@item SIZE_TYPE
1485A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1486for size values.  The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1487contents of the string.
1488
1489The string can contain more than one keyword.  If so, separate them with
1490spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1491appropriate, and finally @code{int}.  The string must exactly match one
1492of the data type names defined in the function
1493@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}.  You may not
1494omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1495crash on startup.
1496
1497If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1498int"}.
1499
1500@findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1501@item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1502A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1503for the result of subtracting two pointers.  The typedef name
1504@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string.  See
1505@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1506
1507If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1508
1509@findex WCHAR_TYPE
1510@item WCHAR_TYPE
1511A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1512for wide characters.  The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1513the contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1514information.
1515
1516If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1517
1518@findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1519@item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1520A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1521characters.  This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1522@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1523
1524@findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1525@item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1526Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1527characters.  If this is undefined, the default is
1528@code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.  Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1529largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.  This is
1530used in @code{cpp}.
1531
1532@findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1533@item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1534A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1535target machine.  If you don't define this, the default is one
1536@code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1537@code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise.  You may want to re-define the type to
1538ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1539
1540@findex WINT_TYPE
1541@item WINT_TYPE
1542A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1543use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1544@code{getwc}.  The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1545contents of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1546information.
1547
1548If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1549
1550@findex INTMAX_TYPE
1551@item INTMAX_TYPE
1552A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1553can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1554The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1555string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1556
1557If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1558@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1559much precision as @code{long long int}.
1560
1561@findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1562@item UINTMAX_TYPE
1563A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1564can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1565type.  The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1566of the string.  See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1567
1568If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1569@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1570unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1571int}.
1572
1573@findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1574@item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1575The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1576that looks like:
1577
1578@example
1579  struct @{
1580    union @{
1581      void (*fn)();
1582      ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1583    @};
1584    ptrdiff_t delta;
1585  @};
1586@end example
1587
1588@noindent
1589The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1590will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1591Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1592always be zero.  Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1593distinguish which variant of the union is in use.  But, on some
1594platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work.  In
1595that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1596the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1597
1598GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1599this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1600However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1601set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1602bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1603address is in ARM or Thumb mode.  If this is the case of your
1604architecture, you should define this macro to
1605@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1606
1607In general, you should not have to define this macro.  On architectures
1608in which function addresses are always even, according to
1609@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1610@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1611
1612@findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1613@item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1614Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables.  This
1615macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1616instead.  Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1617function pointer is actually a small data structure.  Normally the
1618data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1619pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1620
1621If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1622of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1623@end table
1624
1625@node Escape Sequences
1626@section Target Character Escape Sequences
1627@cindex escape sequences
1628
1629By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1630their ASCII values for the target.  If this is not correct, you must
1631explicitly define all of the macros below.
1632
1633@table @code
1634@findex TARGET_BELL
1635@item TARGET_BELL
1636A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1637@samp{\a}.
1638
1639@findex TARGET_ESC
1640@item TARGET_ESC
1641A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1642character.  As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1643@samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1644
1645@findex TARGET_TAB
1646@findex TARGET_BS
1647@findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1648@item TARGET_BS
1649@itemx TARGET_TAB
1650@itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1651C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1652@samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1653
1654@findex TARGET_VT
1655@findex TARGET_FF
1656@findex TARGET_CR
1657@item TARGET_VT
1658@itemx TARGET_FF
1659@itemx TARGET_CR
1660C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1661@samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1662@end table
1663
1664@node Registers
1665@section Register Usage
1666@cindex register usage
1667
1668This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1669has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1670
1671The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1672done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}.  For information
1673on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1674For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1675For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1676
1677@menu
1678* Register Basics::		Number and kinds of registers.
1679* Allocation Order::		Order in which registers are allocated.
1680* Values in Registers::		What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1681* Leaf Functions::		Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1682* Stack Registers::		Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1683@end menu
1684
1685@node Register Basics
1686@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1687
1688@c prevent bad page break with this line
1689Registers have various characteristics.
1690
1691@table @code
1692@findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1693@item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1694Number of hardware registers known to the compiler.  They receive
1695numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1696pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1697@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1698
1699@item FIXED_REGISTERS
1700@findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1701@cindex fixed register
1702An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1703all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1704general allocation.  These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1705pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1706register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1707machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1708and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1709
1710This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1711commas and surrounded by braces.  The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1712register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1713
1714The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1715the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1716by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1717the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1718@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1719
1720@findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1721@item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1722@cindex call-used register
1723@cindex call-clobbered register
1724@cindex call-saved register
1725Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1726clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1727registers.  This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1728available for general allocation of values that must live across
1729function calls.
1730
1731If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1732automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1733exit, if the register is used within the function.
1734
1735@findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1736@item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1737@cindex call-used register
1738@cindex call-clobbered register
1739@cindex call-saved register
1740Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1741that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1742(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1743This macro is optional.  If not specified, it defaults to the value
1744of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1745
1746@findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1747@item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1748@cindex call-used register
1749@cindex call-clobbered register
1750@cindex call-saved register
1751A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1752value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1753call without some part of it being clobbered.  For most machines this
1754macro need not be defined.  It is only required for machines that do not
1755preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1756
1757@findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1758@findex fixed_regs
1759@findex call_used_regs
1760@item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1761Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1762@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1763@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1764any dependence of these register sets on target flags.  The first three
1765of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1766@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1767@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}.  Before the macro is
1768called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1769@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1770from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1771@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1772@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1773@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1774command options have been applied.
1775
1776You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1777
1778@cindex disabling certain registers
1779@cindex controlling register usage
1780If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1781flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1782@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1783registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@.  Also define
1784the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1785is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1786
1787(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1788of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1789controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1790these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1791
1792@findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1793@item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1794If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1795@code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1796@code{longjmp} fails to restore them.  To compensate, the compiler
1797avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1798@code{setjmp}.
1799
1800@findex INCOMING_REGNO
1801@item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1802Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1803expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1804corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1805function.  Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1806outbound register.
1807
1808@findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1809@item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1810Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1811expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1812corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1813function.  Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1814register.
1815
1816@findex LOCAL_REGNO
1817@item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1818Define this macro if the target machine has register windows.  This C
1819expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1820register window.  Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1821need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1822gotos.
1823
1824@ignore
1825@findex PC_REGNUM
1826@item PC_REGNUM
1827If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1828register number.  Otherwise, do not define it.
1829@end ignore
1830@end table
1831
1832@node Allocation Order
1833@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1834@cindex order of register allocation
1835@cindex register allocation order
1836
1837@c prevent bad page break with this line
1838Registers are allocated in order.
1839
1840@table @code
1841@findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1842@item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1843If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1844numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1845to use them (from most preferred to least).
1846
1847If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1848(all else being equal).
1849
1850One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1851registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1852instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers.  On such
1853machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1854the highest numbered allocable register first.
1855
1856@findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1857@item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1858A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1859hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1860
1861Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1862Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1863register; and so on.
1864
1865The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1866@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1867
1868On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1869@end table
1870
1871@node Values in Registers
1872@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
1873
1874This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
1875(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
1876consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
1877
1878@table @code
1879@findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
1880@item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1881A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
1882at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1883@var{mode}.
1884
1885On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
1886definition of this macro is
1887
1888@smallexample
1889#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE)            \
1890   ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)  \
1891    / UNITS_PER_WORD)
1892@end smallexample
1893
1894@findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
1895@item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1896A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
1897of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
1898registers starting with that one).  For a machine where all registers
1899are equivalent, a suitable definition is
1900
1901@smallexample
1902#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
1903@end smallexample
1904
1905You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
1906because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
1907
1908@cindex register pairs
1909On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
1910register pairs.  You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
1911odd register numbers for such modes.
1912
1913The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
1914@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
1915register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
1916value into the register and back out not alter it.
1917
1918Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
1919all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
1920@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
1921you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this.  This
1922is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
1923and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
1924to be tieable.
1925
1926Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
1927Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
1928in floating point registers.  This is not true.  Any registers that
1929can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
1930mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
1931registers.  Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
1932
1933On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
1934modes may not go in floating registers.  This is true if the floating
1935registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
1936non-floating value there would garble it.  In this case,
1937@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
1938floating registers.  But if the floating registers do not automatically
1939normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
1940unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
1941register, so you can define this macro to say so.
1942
1943The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
1944they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
1945instructions.  However, this is of no concern to
1946@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.  You handle it by writing the proper
1947constraints for those instructions.
1948
1949On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
1950so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
1951register if floating point arithmetic is not being done.  As long as the
1952floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
1953be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
1954
1955@findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
1956@item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
1957A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
1958@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
1959
1960If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
1961@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
1962any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
1963should be nonzero.  If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
1964this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
1965accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
1966
1967You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
1968possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
1969allocation.
1970
1971@findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1972@item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
1973Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
1974registers.  You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
1975@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
1976@end table
1977
1978@node Leaf Functions
1979@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
1980
1981@cindex leaf functions
1982@cindex functions, leaf
1983On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
1984more efficiently if it does not make its own register window.  Often this
1985means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
1986are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
1987normally arrive.
1988
1989The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
1990other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
1991registers for its own variables and temporaries.  We use the term ``leaf
1992function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
1993handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
1994functions''.
1995
1996GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
1997suitable for leaf function treatment.  So it needs to renumber the
1998registers in order to output a leaf function.  The following macros
1999accomplish this.
2000
2001@table @code
2002@findex LEAF_REGISTERS
2003@item LEAF_REGISTERS
2004Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2005contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2006function treatment.
2007
2008If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2009registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2010GCC would ordinarily allocate.  The registers which will actually be
2011used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2012in this vector.
2013
2014Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2015the treatment of leaf functions.
2016
2017@findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
2018@item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2019A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2020should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2021
2022If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2023function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2024will cause the compiler to abort.
2025
2026Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2027treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2028this.
2029@end table
2030
2031@findex current_function_is_leaf
2032@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2033@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2034@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2035specially.  They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2036which is nonzero for leaf functions.  @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2037set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2038compiler passes.  They can also test the C variable
2039@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2040functions which only use leaf registers.
2041@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2042only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2043@c changed this to fix overfull.  ALSO:  why the "it" at the beginning
2044@c of the next paragraph?!  --mew 2feb93
2045
2046@node Stack Registers
2047@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2048
2049There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2050``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2051Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2052numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2053
2054Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2055they must be consecutively numbered.
2056
2057@table @code
2058@findex STACK_REGS
2059@item STACK_REGS
2060Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2061
2062@findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2063@item FIRST_STACK_REG
2064The number of the first stack-like register.  This one is the top
2065of the stack.
2066
2067@findex LAST_STACK_REG
2068@item LAST_STACK_REG
2069The number of the last stack-like register.  This one is the bottom of
2070the stack.
2071@end table
2072
2073@node Register Classes
2074@section Register Classes
2075@cindex register class definitions
2076@cindex class definitions, register
2077
2078On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2079For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2080certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions.  These machine
2081restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2082
2083You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2084which of the registers belong to it.  Then you can specify register classes
2085that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2086
2087@findex ALL_REGS
2088@findex NO_REGS
2089In general, each register will belong to several classes.  In fact, one
2090class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers.  Another
2091class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers.  Often the
2092union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2093
2094@findex GENERAL_REGS
2095One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  There is nothing
2096terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2097@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class.  If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2098the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2099to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2100
2101Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2102then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2103
2104The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2105constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2106You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2107them in operand constraints.
2108
2109You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2110instruction allows both classes.  For example, if an instruction allows
2111either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2112certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2113which includes both of them.  Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2114
2115You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2116classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2117contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2118in their union.
2119
2120When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2121certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2122Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2123a register pair to start with an even-numbered register.  The way to
2124specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2125
2126Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2127instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2128each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2129mode to or from memory.  For example, on some machines, the operations for
2130single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers.  When
2131this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2132instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2133single-byte values can be loaded or stored.  This is so that
2134@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2135
2136@table @code
2137@findex enum reg_class
2138@item enum reg_class
2139An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2140as enumeral values.  @code{NO_REGS} must be first.  @code{ALL_REGS}
2141must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2142@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2143tells how many classes there are.
2144
2145Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2146the class name to type @code{int}.  The number serves as an index
2147in many of the tables described below.
2148
2149@findex N_REG_CLASSES
2150@item N_REG_CLASSES
2151The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2152
2153@example
2154#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2155@end example
2156
2157@findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2158@item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2159An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2160constants.  These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2161
2162@findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2163@item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2164An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2165which are bit masks.  The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2166@var{n}.  The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2167register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2168
2169When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2170Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2171several integers.  Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2172for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2173In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2174registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2175so on.
2176
2177@findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2178@item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2179A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2180@var{regno}.  In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2181which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2182register.
2183
2184@findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2185@item BASE_REG_CLASS
2186A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2187base register must belong.  A base register is one used in an address
2188which is the register value plus a displacement.
2189
2190@findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2191@item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2192This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2193the selection of a base register in a mode depenedent manner.  If
2194@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2195@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2196
2197@findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2198@item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2199A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2200index register must belong.  An index register is one used in an
2201address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2202added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2203
2204@findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2205@item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2206A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2207letters for register classes.  If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2208value should be the register class corresponding to it.  Otherwise,
2209the value should be @code{NO_REGS}.  The register letter @samp{r},
2210corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2211to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2212
2213@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2214@item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2215A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2216suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.  It may be
2217either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2218allocated such a hard register.
2219
2220@findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2221@item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2222A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2223that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2224@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2225reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
2226you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2227@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2228
2229@findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2230@item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2231A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2232suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses.  It may be
2233either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2234allocated such a hard register.
2235
2236The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2237the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
2238two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2239labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2240labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2241may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
2242looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2243only if neither labeling works.
2244
2245@findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2246@item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2247A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2248to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2249@var{class}.  The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2250another, smaller class.  On many machines, the following definition is
2251safe:
2252
2253@example
2254#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2255@end example
2256
2257Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code.  For
2258example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2259for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2260@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2261Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2262
2263If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2264you can force @var{x} into a memory constant.  This is useful on
2265certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2266certain kinds of registers.
2267
2268@findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2269@item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2270Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2271input reloads.  If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2272@var{class}, unchanged.
2273
2274@findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2275@item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2276A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2277to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2278@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2279ordinarily be used.
2280
2281Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2282there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2283
2284The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2285smaller class.
2286
2287Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2288require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2289
2290@findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2291@findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2292@findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2293@item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2294@itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2295@itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2296Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2297from memory or even from other types of registers.  An example is the
2298@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2299from general registers, but not memory.  Some machines allow copying all
2300registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2301to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2302and those with certain symbolic address on the Sparc when compiling
2303PIC)@.  In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2304required.
2305
2306You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2307need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2308register to contain the data.  Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2309register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2310you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2311largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2312intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2313
2314If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2315intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2316should be defined to return the largest register class required.  If the
2317requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2318@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2319macros identically.
2320
2321The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2322Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2323can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2324@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register.  Do not define this
2325macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2326
2327If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2328intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2329@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2330(@pxref{Standard Names}.  These patterns, which will normally be
2331implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2332@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2333register.
2334
2335Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2336contain a single register class.  If the original reload register (whose
2337class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2338value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2339register.  Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2340Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2341
2342@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2343pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2344Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2345in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2346
2347These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2348registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2349registers.  In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2350would not be helpful.  Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2351the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2352intermediate storage.  This case often occurs between floating-point and
2353general registers.
2354
2355@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2356@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2357Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2358to some other registers without using memory.  Define this macro on
2359those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2360@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2361class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2362and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2363
2364Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2365
2366@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2367@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2368Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2369allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2370If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2371defined by this macro.
2372
2373Do not define this macro if you do not define
2374@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2375
2376@findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2377@item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2378When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2379registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2380hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2381load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2382same as that of @var{mode}.
2383
2384This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2385bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2386in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2387registers.
2388
2389However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2390the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2391differently than in integer registers.  On those machines, the default
2392widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2393suppress that widening in some cases.  See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2394details.
2395
2396Do not define this macro if you do not define
2397@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2398is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2399
2400@findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2401@item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2402On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2403insns.  Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2404to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2405if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2406insn.
2407
2408Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2409value on these machines.  When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2410compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2411
2412It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2413unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2414that can be performed in some cases.  If you do not define this macro
2415with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2416spill registers and print a fatal error message.  For most machines, you
2417should not define this macro at all.
2418
2419@findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2420@item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2421A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2422to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2423registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2424
2425The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2426register and zero otherwise.  On most machines, this default should be
2427used.  Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2428allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2429registers were needed for spill registers.  If this macro returns nonzero
2430for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2431@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2432register.  If there would not be another register available for
2433reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2434the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2435allocation.
2436
2437@findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2438@item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2439A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2440of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2441
2442This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.  In fact,
2443the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2444should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2445@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2446
2447This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2448in the reload pass.
2449
2450@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE
2451If defined, a C expression for a class that contains registers for
2452which the compiler may not change modes arbitrarily.
2453
2454@item CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P(@var{from}, @var{to})
2455A C expression that is true if, for a register in
2456@code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}, the requested mode punning is invalid.
2457
2458For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2459floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2460Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2461does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2462register.  Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE}
2463as @code{FLOAT_REGS} and @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} restricts
2464mode changes to same-size modes.
2465
2466Compare this to IA-64, which extends floating-point values to 82 bits,
2467and stores 64-bit integers in a different format than 64-bit doubles.
2468Therefore @code{CLASS_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P} is always true.
2469@end table
2470
2471Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2472letters.
2473
2474@table @code
2475@findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2476@item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2477A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2478letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2479particular ranges of integer values.  If @var{c} is one of those
2480letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2481the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is
2482not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2483@var{value}.
2484
2485@findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2486@item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2487A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2488letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2489(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2490
2491If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2492@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2493range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise.  If @var{c} is not one of those
2494letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2495
2496@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2497@code{DImode} fixed-point constants.  A given letter can accept either
2498or both kinds of values.  It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2499between these kinds.
2500
2501@findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2502@item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2503A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2504letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2505memory references, for the target machine.  Any letter that is not
2506elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}
2507may be used.  Normally this macro will not be defined.
2508
2509If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2510if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2511constraint letter @var{c}.  If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2512constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2513
2514For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2515in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address.  Constraint
2516letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2517@emph{not} contain a symbolic address.  An alternative is specified with
2518a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output.  The next
2519alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2520does not include r0 on the output.
2521@end table
2522
2523@node Stack and Calling
2524@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2525@cindex calling conventions
2526
2527@c prevent bad page break with this line
2528This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2529
2530@menu
2531* Frame Layout::
2532* Exception Handling::
2533* Stack Checking::
2534* Frame Registers::
2535* Elimination::
2536* Stack Arguments::
2537* Register Arguments::
2538* Scalar Return::
2539* Aggregate Return::
2540* Caller Saves::
2541* Function Entry::
2542* Profiling::
2543* Tail Calls::
2544@end menu
2545
2546@node Frame Layout
2547@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2548@cindex stack frame layout
2549@cindex frame layout
2550
2551@c prevent bad page break with this line
2552Here is the basic stack layout.
2553
2554@table @code
2555@findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2556@item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2557Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2558pointer to a smaller address.
2559
2560When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2561compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2562definition used does not matter.
2563
2564@findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2565@item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2566
2567This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2568on the stack.  In RTL, a push operation will be
2569@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) ...)}
2570
2571The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2572and @code{POST_INC}.  Which of these is correct depends on
2573the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2574to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2575space for the next item on the stack.
2576
2577The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2578defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2579which is often wrong.
2580
2581@findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2582@item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2583Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2584offsets from the frame pointer.
2585
2586@findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2587@item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2588Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2589addresses on the stack.
2590
2591@findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2592@item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2593Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2594
2595If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2596subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2597Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2598value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2599@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2600@c rid of an overfull.  --mew 2feb93
2601
2602@findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2603@item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2604Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2605outgoing arguments are placed.  If not specified, the default value of
2606zero is used.  This is the proper value for most machines.
2607
2608If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2609the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2610
2611@findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2612@item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2613Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2614address.  On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2615function.
2616
2617If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2618the first argument's address.
2619
2620@findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2621@item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2622Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2623on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2624
2625The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2626length of the outgoing arguments.  The default is correct for most
2627machines.  See @file{function.c} for details.
2628
2629@findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2630@item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2631A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2632frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored.  Assume that
2633@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2634itself.
2635
2636If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2637of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2638address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2639
2640@findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2641@item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2642If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2643setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed.  For example,
2644on the Sparc, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2645before we can access arbitrary stack frames.  You will seldom need to
2646define this macro.
2647
2648@findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2649@item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2650If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2651the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2652The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2653machines.  One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2654@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2655
2656@findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2657@item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2658A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2659address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2660the prologue.  @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2661frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2662@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2663
2664The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2665@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2666determine the return address of other frames.
2667
2668@findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2669@item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2670Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2671from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2672
2673@findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2674@item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2675A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2676incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2677prologue.  This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2678value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2679the stack.
2680
2681You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2682debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2683
2684If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2685@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2686
2687@findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2688@item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2689A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2690from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2691frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue.  The top of
2692the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2693previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2694
2695You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2696debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2697
2698@findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2699@item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2700A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2701from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).  The
2702final value should coincide with that calculated by
2703@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.  Which is unfortunately not usable
2704during virtual register instantiation.
2705
2706The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2707which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2708immediately before the stack frame.  Note that this is not the case on
2709some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2710and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2711
2712You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2713want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2714DWARF 2.
2715
2716@findex SMALL_STACK
2717@item SMALL_STACK
2718Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small.  This
2719has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2720@samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2721@end table
2722
2723@node Exception Handling
2724@subsection Exception Handling Support
2725@cindex exception handling
2726
2727@table @code
2728@findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2729@item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2730A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2731data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2732@var{N} registers are usable.
2733
2734The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2735handlers via a set of agreed upon registers.  Ideally these registers
2736should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2737but may negatively impact code size.  The target must support at least
27382 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2739
2740You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2741handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2742
2743@findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2744@item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2745A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2746to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2747This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2748It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2749
2750Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2751untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2752
2753You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2754handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2755
2756@findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2757@item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2758A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2759to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2760return.  It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2761
2762Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2763return address is stored.  For targets that return by popping an
2764address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2765the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2766frame.  @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2767so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2768
2769Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2770address calculable during initial code generation.  In that case
2771the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2772
2773If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
2774define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
2775
2776@findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
2777@item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
2778This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
2779handling sections.  If at all possible, this should be defined such
2780that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
2781and so may be read-only.
2782
2783@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
2784@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2785The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
2786as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
2787
2788If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2789represented directly.
2790
2791@findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
2792@item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2793This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
2794to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
2795Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
2796be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
2797
2798This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
2799handled.  @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
2800of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2801to be emitted.
2802
2803@findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
2804@item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
2805This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
2806code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
2807available.  The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
2808through signal frames.
2809
2810This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
2811and @file{unwind-ia64.c}.  @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
2812@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}.  Examine @code{context->ra}
2813for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
2814the stack pointer value.  If the frame can be decoded, the register save
2815addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
2816@var{success}.  If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
2817nothing.
2818@end table
2819
2820@node Stack Checking
2821@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
2822
2823GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
2824the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
2825
2826@enumerate
2827@item
2828If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
2829will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
2830appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
2831@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}.  GCC will do not other special
2832processing.
2833
2834@item
2835If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
2836called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
2837pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
2838value against.  You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
2839the stack pointer is out of range.
2840
2841@item
2842If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
2843``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
2844@end enumerate
2845
2846Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
2847will use the third approach.
2848
2849@table @code
2850@findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2851@item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
2852A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
2853machine-dependent manner.  You should define this macro if stack checking
2854is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
2855checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
2856The default value of this macro is zero.
2857
2858@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2859@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
2860An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
2861probe instructions.  You will normally define this macro to be no larger
2862than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area.  The
2863default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
2864
2865@findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2866@item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
2867A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
2868as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
2869The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
2870
2871@findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2872@item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
2873The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
2874for languages where such a recovery is supported.  The default value of
287575 words should be adequate for most machines.
2876
2877@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2878@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
2879The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes.  GCC will generate probe
2880instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
2881stack are available.  If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
2882checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning.  The
2883default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
2884systems.  You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
2885
2886@findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2887@item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
2888GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message.  It
2889represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
2890space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
2891You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
2892use the default of four words.
2893
2894@findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2895@item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
2896The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
2897fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
2898@option{-fstack-check}.
2899GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
2900normally not need to override that default.
2901@end table
2902
2903@need 2000
2904@node Frame Registers
2905@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
2906
2907@c prevent bad page break with this line
2908This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
2909
2910@table @code
2911@findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2912@item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2913The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
2914fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}.  On most machines,
2915the hardware determines which register this is.
2916
2917@findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2918@item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2919The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
2920access automatic variables in the stack frame.  On some machines, the
2921hardware determines which register this is.  On other machines, you can
2922choose any register you wish for this purpose.
2923
2924@findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2925@item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2926On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
2927offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
2928allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
2929between these two locations).  On those machines, define
2930@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
2931be used internally until the offset is known, and define
2932@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
2933used for the frame pointer.
2934
2935You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
2936is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
2937the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
2938completed.  When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
2939definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
2940@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
2941or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2942
2943Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
2944@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
2945
2946@findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2947@item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
2948The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
2949the function's argument list.  On some machines, this is the same as the
2950frame pointer register.  On some machines, the hardware determines which
2951register this is.  On other machines, you can choose any register you
2952wish for this purpose.  If this is not the same register as the frame
2953pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
2954@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
2955(@pxref{Elimination}).
2956
2957@findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2958@item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
2959The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
2960access the current function's return address from the stack.  On some
2961machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
2962pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer.  This register can be defined
2963to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
2964@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
2965
2966Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
2967address from the stack.
2968
2969@findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2970@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2971@item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
2972@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
2973Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer.  If
2974register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
2975function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
2976number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}.  If
2977these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
2978not be defined.
2979
2980The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
2981
2982If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2983defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
2984
2985@findex STATIC_CHAIN
2986@findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2987@item STATIC_CHAIN
2988@itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
2989If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
2990@code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
2991@code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
2992as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively.  Often the former
2993will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
2994the frame pointer.
2995
2996@findex stack_pointer_rtx
2997@findex frame_pointer_rtx
2998@findex arg_pointer_rtx
2999The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3000@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3001macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3002
3003If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3004be defined instead.
3005
3006@findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3007@item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3008This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3009saved in a call frame.  This is used to size data structures used in
3010DWARF2 exception handling.
3011
3012Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3013exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3014extensions.  In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3015in the number of hard registers.  Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3016used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3017routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3018registers that are not call-saved.
3019
3020If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3021@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3022
3023@findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3024@item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3025
3026This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3027for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3028
3029If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3030@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3031
3032@end table
3033
3034@node Elimination
3035@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3036
3037@c prevent bad page break with this line
3038This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3042@item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3043A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3044pointer.  This expression is evaluated  in the reload pass.  If its value is
3045nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3046
3047The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3048according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3049constant 1 suffices.  Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3050with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.  Use 1
3051when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3052
3053In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3054without a frame pointer.  The compiler recognizes those cases and
3055automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3056@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says.  You don't need to worry about
3057them.
3058
3059In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3060register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3061fixed register.  See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3062
3063@findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3064@findex get_frame_size
3065@item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3066A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3067between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3068the function prologue.  The value would be computed from information
3069such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3070registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3071
3072If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3073need not be defined.  Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3074@code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3075case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3076
3077@findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3078@item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3079If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3080eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.  If it is not
3081defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3082references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3083
3084The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3085of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3086
3087On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3088the compilation is completed.  In such a case, a separate hard register
3089must be used for the argument pointer.  This register can be eliminated by
3090replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3091depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3092
3093In this case, you might specify:
3094@example
3095#define ELIMINABLE_REGS  \
3096@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3097 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3098 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3099@end example
3100
3101Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3102specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3103
3104@findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3105@item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3106A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3107to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3108@var{to-reg}.  This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3109is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3110preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3111knows about.
3112
3113@findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3114@item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3115This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}.  It
3116specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3117registers.  This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3118defined.
3119@end table
3120
3121@node Stack Arguments
3122@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3123@cindex arguments on stack
3124@cindex stack arguments
3125
3126The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3127on the stack.  See the following section for other macros that
3128control passing certain arguments in registers.
3129
3130@table @code
3131@findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3132@item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3133A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3134a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3135actually be passed as an @code{int}.  In addition to avoiding
3136errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3137code on certain machines.  If the macro is not defined in target
3138header files, it defaults to 0.
3139
3140@findex PUSH_ARGS
3141@item PUSH_ARGS
3142A C expression.  If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3143outgoing arguments.
3144If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3145That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3146allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3147it.  When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3148On some machines, the definition
3149
3150@findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3151@item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3152A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3153stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3154
3155On some machines, the definition
3156
3157@example
3158#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3159@end example
3160
3161@noindent
3162will suffice.  But on other machines, instructions that appear
3163to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3164alignment.  Then the definition should be
3165
3166@example
3167#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3168@end example
3169
3170@findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3171@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3172@item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3173A C expression.  If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3174will be computed and placed into the variable
3175@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.  No space will be pushed
3176onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3177increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3178
3179Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3180is not proper.
3181
3182@findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3183@item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3184Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3185allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3186registers.
3187
3188The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3189arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3190which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3191
3192This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3193machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3194which.
3195@c above is overfull.  not sure what to do.  --mew 5feb93  did
3196@c something, not sure if it looks good.  --mew 10feb93
3197
3198@findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3199@findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3200@item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3201@itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3202Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3203allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3204in registers.  These should be used when the stack space allocated
3205for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3206function declaration.
3207
3208The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3209we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3210
3211The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3212that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers.  This takes two
3213arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3214arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3215variable sized arguments on the stack.
3216
3217When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3218called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3219being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3220In each case this value can be easily computed.
3221
3222When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3223much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3224@code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3225
3226@findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3227@item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3228Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3229reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3230
3231If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3232whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3233@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3234
3235@findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3236@item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3237Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3238stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3239@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3240@c overfull.. not as specific, tho.  --mew 5feb93
3241
3242Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3243stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area.  Defining this macro
3244suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3245stack in its natural location.
3246
3247@findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3248@item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3249A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3250arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3251function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3252after the function returns.
3253
3254@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3255the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3256@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3257From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3258
3259@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3260describes the function in question.  Normally it is a node of type
3261@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3262From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3263arguments (if known).
3264
3265When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3266will contain an identifier node for the library function.  Thus, if
3267you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3268by their names.  Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3269a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3270in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3271
3272@var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3273stack.  If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3274argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3275
3276On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3277of this macro is @var{stack-size}.  On the 68000, using the standard
3278calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3279the macro is always 0 in this case.  But an alternative calling
3280convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3281arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3282nothing (the caller pops all).  When this convention is in use,
3283@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3284number of arguments.
3285
3286@findex CALL_POPS_ARGS
3287@item   CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3288A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3289pops off the stack.  It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3290when compiling a function call.
3291
3292@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3293have been accumulated.
3294
3295On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3296that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3297that have been passed to the function.  Since this is a property of the
3298call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3299appropriate.
3300
3301@end table
3302
3303@node Register Arguments
3304@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3305@cindex arguments in registers
3306@cindex registers arguments
3307
3308This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3309types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3310the stack.
3311
3312@table @code
3313@findex FUNCTION_ARG
3314@item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3315A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3316in a register, and which register.
3317
3318The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3319arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3320the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3321(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3322which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3323correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3324@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3325occurred.
3326
3327The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3328hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3329argument on the stack.
3330
3331For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3332pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3333
3334The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@.  This is
3335used when an argument is passed in multiple locations.  The mode of the
3336of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument.  The
3337@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3338describes where part of the argument is passed.  In each
3339@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3340register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3341register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is.  The
3342second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3343the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3344As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3345RTX may have a first operand of zero.  This indicates that the entire
3346argument is also stored on the stack.
3347
3348The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3349VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3350pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3351
3352@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3353The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3354where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3355nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead.  This is done
3356by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3357
3358@cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3359@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3360You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3361in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3362type that must be passed in the stack.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3363is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3364argument, the compiler will abort.  If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3365defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3366a register.
3367
3368@findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3369@item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3370Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3371to pass TYPE solely in registers.  The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3372definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3373documentation.
3374
3375@findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3376@item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3377Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3378that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3379necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3380argument.
3381
3382For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3383the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3384be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3385where the arguments will arrive.
3386
3387If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3388serves both purposes.
3389
3390@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3391@item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3392A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3393argument, that must be put in registers.  The value must be zero for
3394arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3395pushed on the stack.
3396
3397On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3398registers and partially in memory.  On these machines, typically the
3399first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3400on the stack.  If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3401structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3402in registers and the rest must be pushed.  This macro tells the
3403compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3404registers.
3405
3406@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3407register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3408@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3409
3410@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3411@item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3412A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3413If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3414pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3415The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3416to that type.
3417
3418On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3419definition of this macro might be
3420@smallexample
3421#define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3422(CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED)  \
3423  MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3424@end smallexample
3425@c this is *still* too long.  --mew 5feb93
3426
3427@findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3428@item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3429If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3430responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3431Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3432routine being called.  When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3433nonzero, the caller does not make a copy.  Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3434``live'' value.  The called function must not modify this value.  If it can be
3435determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3436otherwise a copy must be made.
3437
3438@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3439@item FUNCTION_ARG_REG_LITTLE_ENDIAN
3440If defined TRUE on a big-endian system then structure arguments passed
3441(and returned) in registers are passed in a little-endian manner instead of
3442the big-endian manner.  On the HP-UX IA64 and PA64 platforms structures are
3443aligned differently then integral values and setting this value to true will
3444allow for the special handling of structure arguments and return values.
3445
3446@findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3447@item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3448A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3449@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values.  For some target machines,
3450the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3451argument so far.
3452
3453There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3454arguments that have been passed on the stack.  The compiler has other
3455variables to keep track of that.  For target machines on which all
3456arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3457@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3458should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3459
3460@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3461@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{indirect})
3462A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable @var{cum}
3463for the state at the beginning of the argument list.  The variable has
3464type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.  The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3465for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0
3466if the args are to a compiler support library function.  The value of
3467@var{indirect} is nonzero when processing an indirect call, for example
3468a call through a function pointer.  The value of @var{indirect} is zero
3469for a call to an explicitly named function, a library function call, or when
3470@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
3471being compiled.
3472
3473When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3474@var{libname} identifies which one.  It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3475contains the name of the function, as a string.  @var{libname} is 0 when
3476an ordinary C function call is being processed.  Thus, each time this
3477macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3478never both of them at once.
3479
3480@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3481@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3482Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3483it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3484@code{NULL}.  @var{indirect} would always be zero, too.  If this macro
3485is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
34860)} is used instead.
3487
3488@findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3489@item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3490Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3491finding the arguments for the function being compiled.  If this macro is
3492undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3493
3494The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3495with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@.  The
3496argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3497@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3498@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3499@c --mew 5feb93   i switched the order of the sentences.  --mew 10feb93
3500
3501@findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3502@item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3503A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3504@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list.  The
3505values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3506Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3507the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3508
3509This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3510on the stack.  The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3511used for arguments without any special help.
3512
3513@findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3514@item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3515If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3516to pad out an argument with extra space.  The value should be of type
3517@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3518@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3519
3520The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3521multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3522it.
3523
3524This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3525For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward.  For
3526big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3527constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3528
3529@findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3530@item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3531If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3532implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3533next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3534controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.  If this macro is not defined, all such
3535arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3536
3537@findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3538@item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3539If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3540of an argument with the specified mode and type.  If it is not defined,
3541@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3542
3543@findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3544@item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3545A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3546register in which function arguments are sometimes passed.  This does
3547@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3548the structure-value address.  On many machines, no registers can be
3549used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3550stack.
3551
3552@findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3553@item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3554If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3555respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3556argument is loaded first.  This macro only affects arguments
3557passed in registers.
3558
3559@end table
3560
3561@node Scalar Return
3562@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3563@cindex return values in registers
3564@cindex values, returned by functions
3565@cindex scalars, returned as values
3566
3567This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3568values---values that can fit in registers.
3569
3570@table @code
3571@findex TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3572@item TRADITIONAL_RETURN_FLOAT
3573Define this macro if @option{-traditional} should not cause functions
3574declared to return @code{float} to convert the value to @code{double}.
3575
3576@findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3577@item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3578A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3579function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}.  @var{valtype} is
3580a tree node representing a data type.  Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3581(@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3582On many machines, only the mode is relevant.  (Actually, on most
3583machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3584mode).
3585
3586The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3587register where the return value is stored.  The value can also be a
3588@code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places.  See
3589@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3590
3591If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3592promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3593scalar type.
3594
3595If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3596node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3597pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3598convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3599known.
3600
3601@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3602types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3603@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3604
3605@findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3606@item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3607Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3608so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3609the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3610
3611For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3612the caller will see the value.  @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3613defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3614value.
3615
3616If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3617@code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3618
3619@code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3620aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way.  See
3621@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3622
3623@findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3624@item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3625A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3626function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.  If the precise function
3627being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3628(@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3629pointer.  This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3630convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3631known.
3632
3633Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3634support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3635specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3636compiled.
3637
3638The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3639data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3640
3641@findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3642@item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3643A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3644register in which the values of called function may come back.
3645
3646A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3647second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3648recognized by this macro.  So for most machines, this definition
3649suffices:
3650
3651@example
3652#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3653@end example
3654
3655If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3656function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3657should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3658
3659@findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3660@item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3661Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3662need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3663saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3664@end table
3665
3666@node Aggregate Return
3667@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3668@cindex aggregates as return values
3669@cindex large return values
3670@cindex returning aggregate values
3671@cindex structure value address
3672
3673When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3674cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3675(@pxref{Scalar Return}).  Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3676block of memory in which the value should be stored.  This address
3677is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3678
3679This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3680memory.
3681
3682@table @code
3683@findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3684@item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3685A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3686values in registers, based on the type of value.  A nonzero value says
3687to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3688always returned.  Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3689@code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3690
3691Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3692by this macro.  Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3693takes effect regardless of this macro.  On most systems, it is
3694possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3695definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3696values, and 0 otherwise.
3697
3698Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3699be returned in memory.  You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3700to indicate this.
3701
3702@findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3703@item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3704Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3705in memory.  Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3706only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3707If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3708and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3709
3710If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3711
3712@findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3713@item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3714If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3715@code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3716
3717@findex STRUCT_VALUE
3718@item STRUCT_VALUE
3719If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3720@code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3721where the address is passed.  If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3722an ``invisible'' first argument.
3723
3724@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3725@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3726On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3727is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3728caller put it.  This can be due to register windows, or it could
3729be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3730
3731If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3732register, define this macro as the register number.
3733
3734@findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3735@item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3736If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3737@code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3738called function should find the value.  If it should find the value on
3739the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3740pointer.  A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3741``invisible'' first argument.
3742
3743@findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3744@item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3745Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3746for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3747the address of a static variable containing the value.
3748
3749Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3750pass an address to the subroutine.
3751
3752This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3753nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3754@end table
3755
3756@node Caller Saves
3757@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3758
3759If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls.  This
3760makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3761must live across calls.
3762
3763@table @code
3764@findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3765@item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3766Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3767any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3768for all registers.  When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3769by default for all optimization levels.  It has no effect for optimization
3770levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3771
3772@findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3773@item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3774A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3775a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3776restoring it around each function call.  The expression should be 1 when
3777this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3778
3779If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3780machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3781
3782@findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3783@item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3784A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3785of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}.  If
3786@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3787returned.  For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3788will select the smallest suitable mode.
3789@end table
3790
3791@node Function Entry
3792@subsection Function Entry and Exit
3793@cindex function entry and exit
3794@cindex prologue
3795@cindex epilogue
3796
3797This section describes the macros that output function entry
3798(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
3799
3800@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3801If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
3802function.  The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
3803initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
3804saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
3805local variables.  @var{size} is an integer.  @var{file} is a stdio
3806stream to which the assembler code should be output.
3807
3808The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
3809macro.  That has already been done when the macro is run.
3810
3811@findex regs_ever_live
3812To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
3813@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
3814@var{r} is used anywhere within the function.  This implies the function
3815prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
3816call-used registers.  (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
3817@code{regs_ever_live}.)
3818
3819On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
3820not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
3821they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
3822appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
3823registers are used in the function.
3824
3825@findex frame_pointer_needed
3826On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3827function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
3828pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise.  To determine whether a
3829frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3830@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 at run
3831time in a function that needs a frame pointer.  @xref{Elimination}.
3832
3833The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
3834required for the function.  This stack space consists of the regions
3835listed below.  In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
3836order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
3837stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
3838the highest address if it is not defined).  You can use a different order
3839for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
3840compatibility reasons.  Except in cases where required by standard
3841or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
3842need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
3843@end deftypefn
3844
3845@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3846If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
3847prologue.  This should be used when the function prologue is being
3848emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3849emitted.  @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
3850@end deftypefn
3851
3852@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
3853If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
3854epilogue.  This should be used when the function epilogue is being
3855emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
3856emitted.  @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
3857@end deftypefn
3858
3859@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
3860If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
3861function.  The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
3862registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
3863called, and returning control to the caller.  This macro takes the
3864same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
3865registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
3866@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
3867
3868On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
3869of returning from the function.  On these machines, give that
3870instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
3871@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
3872
3873Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
3874@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used.  If you want the target
3875switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
3876define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
3877target switches appropriately.  If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
3878condition is false, epilogues will be used.
3879
3880On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
3881function exit code must vary accordingly.  Sometimes the code for these
3882two cases is completely different.  To determine whether a frame pointer
3883is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
3884@code{frame_pointer_needed}.  The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
3885a function that needs a frame pointer.
3886
3887Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3888@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
3889The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3890function.  @xref{Leaf Functions}.
3891
3892On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
3893others leave that for the caller to do.  For example, the 68020 when
3894given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
3895number of arguments.
3896
3897@findex current_function_pops_args
3898Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
3899functions pop their own arguments.  @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
3900needs to know what was decided.  The variable that is called
3901@code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
3902arguments that a function should pop.  @xref{Scalar Return}.
3903@c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
3904@c tell?  --mew 5feb93
3905@end deftypefn
3906
3907@table @code
3908
3909@itemize @bullet
3910@item
3911@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
3912A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
3913uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
3914stack.  (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
3915if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
3916arguments.  But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
3917yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.)  This
3918region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
3919registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
3920features in @code{<varargs.h>} and @code{<stdarg.h>}.
3921
3922@item
3923An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
3924The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
3925the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
3926machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
3927in the function.  Machines with register windows often do not require
3928a save area.
3929
3930@item
3931A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
3932boundary, to contain the local variables of the function.  On some machines,
3933this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
3934save area closer to the top of the stack.
3935
3936@item
3937@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
3938Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
3939@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
3940argument lists of the function.  @xref{Stack Arguments}.
3941@end itemize
3942
3943Normally, it is necessary for the macros
3944@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
3945@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
3946The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
3947function.
3948
3949@findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3950@item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
3951Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
3952instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
3953pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
3954adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
3955
3956Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
3957frame pointers are maintained.  It is never safe to delete a final
3958stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
3959compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
3960
3961@findex EPILOGUE_USES
3962@item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3963Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3964used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern.  The stack and frame
3965pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
3966
3967@findex EH_USES
3968@item EH_USES (@var{regno})
3969Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
3970used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
3971on entry to an exception edge.
3972
3973@findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3974@item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
3975Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
3976instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''.  The
3977definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
3978representing the number of delay slots there.
3979
3980@findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
3981@item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
3982A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
3983slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
3984
3985The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
3986being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
3987eligibility).  It is never negative and is always less than the number
3988of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
3989If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
3990may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot.  Also, other insns may
3991(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
3992slot.
3993
3994@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
3995@findex final_scan_insn
3996The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
3997list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
3998@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}.  The insn for the first
3999delay slot comes first in the list.  Your definition of the macro
4000@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4001outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4002@code{final_scan_insn}.
4003
4004You need not define this macro if you did not define
4005@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4006
4007@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4008@item ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (@var{file}, @var{thunk_fndecl}, @var{delta}, @var{function})
4009A C compound statement that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4010function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4011inheritance.  The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4012adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4013the real function.
4014
4015First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4016contains the incoming first argument.  Assume that this argument
4017contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4018in C++.  This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4019e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc.  The addition must preserve the values of
4020all other incoming arguments.
4021
4022After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4023@code{FUNCTION_DECL}.  This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4024not touch the return address.  Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4025return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4026
4027The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4028the adjusted first argument.  This macro is responsible for emitting all
4029of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4030and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4031
4032The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant.  (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4033have already been extracted from it.)  It might possibly be useful on
4034some targets, but probably not.
4035
4036If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4037front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4038@var{function} instead of jumping to it.  The generic approach does
4039not support varargs.
4040@end table
4041
4042@node Profiling
4043@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4044@cindex profiling, code generation
4045
4046These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4047
4048@table @code
4049@findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4050@item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4051A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4052assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4053
4054@findex mcount
4055The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4056your operating system environment, not by GCC@.  To figure them out,
4057compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4058compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4059
4060Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4061variable to be loaded into some register.  The name of this variable is
4062@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4063the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4064
4065@findex PROFILE_HOOK
4066@item PROFILE_HOOK
4067A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4068code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4069not support profiling.
4070
4071@findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4072@item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4073Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4074not need a counter variable allocated for each function.  This is true
4075for almost all modern implementations.  If you define this macro, you
4076must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4077
4078@findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4079@item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4080Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4081the function prologue.  Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4082
4083
4084@findex TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4085@item TARGET_ALLOWS_PROFILING_WITHOUT_FRAME_POINTER
4086On some targets, it is impossible to use profiling when the frame
4087pointer has been omitted.  For example, on x86 GNU/Linux systems,
4088the @code{mcount} routine provided by the GNU C Library finds the
4089address of the routine that called the routine that called @code{mcount}
4090by looking in the immediate caller's stack frame.  If the immediate
4091caller has no frame pointer, this lookup will fail.
4092
4093By default, GCC assumes that the target does allow profiling when the
4094frame pointer is omitted.  This macro should be defined to a C
4095expression that evaluates to @code{false} if the target does not allow
4096profiling when the frame pointer is omitted.
4097
4098@end table
4099
4100@node Tail Calls
4101@subsection Permitting tail calls
4102@cindex tail calls
4103
4104@table @code
4105@findex FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4106@item FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (@var{decl})
4107A C expression that evaluates to true if it is ok to perform a sibling
4108call to @var{decl} from the current function.
4109
4110It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4111tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4112during PIC compilation.  Use this macro to enforce these restrictions,
4113as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4114``normal'' call.
4115@end table
4116
4117@node Varargs
4118@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4119@cindex varargs implementation
4120
4121GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4122@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4123on the stack.  Other machines require their own implementations of
4124varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4125conditionals to include it.
4126
4127ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4128the calling convention for @code{va_start}.  The traditional
4129implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4130to store the argument pointer.  The ISO implementation of
4131@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument.  The user is
4132supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4133
4134However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument.  The way to find
4135the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4136below.
4137
4138@table @code
4139@findex __builtin_saveregs
4140@item __builtin_saveregs ()
4141Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4142that the varargs mechanism can access them.  Both ISO and traditional
4143versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4144you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4145
4146On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4147control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  On other machines,
4148it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4149@file{libgcc2.c}.
4150
4151Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4152beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4153@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4154This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4155to use them for its own purposes.
4156@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4157@c 10feb93
4158
4159@findex __builtin_args_info
4160@item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4161Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4162registers.
4163
4164In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4165arguments, each for a particular category of data types.  (For example,
4166on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4167arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4168To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4169have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4170registers in each category have been used so far
4171
4172@code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4173@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4174with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access.  Thus, the
4175value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4176
4177Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4178of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4179value in the @code{va_list} object.  This is because @code{va_list} will
4180have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4181values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4182
4183@findex __builtin_next_arg
4184@item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4185This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4186arguments.  It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4187argument, as type @code{void *}.  If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4188returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4189argument.  Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4190fetching arguments from the stack.  Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4191verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4192of the current function.
4193
4194@findex __builtin_classify_type
4195@item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4196Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4197passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4198has to embody these conventions.  The easiest way to categorize the
4199specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4200with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4201
4202@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4203considering only its data type.  It returns an integer describing what
4204kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4205
4206The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4207interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4208@end table
4209
4210These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4211
4212@table @code
4213@findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4214@item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4215If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4216for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}.  This code will be moved to the
4217very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4218The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4219value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4220
4221@findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4222@item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4223This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4224defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}.  Use it to store the
4225anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4226appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack.  Once this is
4227done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4228machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4229
4230The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4231structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4232named arguments.  The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4233last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4234
4235The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4236stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4237arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4238@code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4239@var{pretend_args_size}.  The value that you store here will serve as
4240additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4241
4242Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4243compile time without knowing their data types,
4244@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4245a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4246types.
4247
4248If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4249arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time.  This
4250happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4251end of the source file.  The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4252not generate any instructions in this case.
4253
4254@findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4255@item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4256Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4257argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4258
4259This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4260is set for varargs and stdarg functions.  If this macro returns a
4261nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4262arguments, and false for unnamed arguments.  If it returns a value of
4263zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4264are treated as named.  Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4265are treated as named.
4266
4267You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4268
4269@findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4270@item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4271If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4272@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4273@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4274defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4275@code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4276Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4277@end table
4278
4279@node Trampolines
4280@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4281@cindex trampolines for nested functions
4282@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4283
4284A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4285when the address of a nested function is taken.  It normally resides on
4286the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.  These macros
4287tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4288trampoline.
4289
4290The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4291address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4292the nested function.  On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4293two instructions, a move immediate and a jump.  Then the two addresses
4294exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.  On RISC
4295machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4296two parts.  Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4297operands.
4298
4299The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4300parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4301immediate operands of the instructions.  On a CISC machine, this is
4302simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4303proper offset from the start of the trampoline.  On a RISC machine, it
4304may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4305separately.
4306
4307@table @code
4308@findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4309@item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4310A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4311block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline.  This
4312code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4313automatically.
4314
4315If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4316for the target.  Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4317code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4318to generate it on the spot.
4319
4320@findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4321@item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4322The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4323trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is
4324a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4325the section containing read-only data.
4326
4327@findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4328@item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4329A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4330
4331@findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4332@item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4333Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4334
4335If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4336is used for aligning trampolines.
4337
4338@findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4339@item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4340A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4341@var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4342an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4343RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4344when it is called.
4345
4346@findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4347@item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4348A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4349the address of the trampoline.  Its argument contains the address that
4350was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}.  In case the address to be
4351used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4352the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4353@var{addr}.  If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4354function calls.
4355
4356@findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4357@item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4358A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline.  The
4359expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4360space for the trampoline.
4361
4362@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4363@cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4364If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4365a stack slot.  This default is right for most machines.  The exceptions
4366are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4367area.  On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4368using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4369and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4370
4371@var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4372describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4373the function which the trampoline is for.  Normally (when
4374@code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4375trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function.  Other
4376allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4377information.
4378@end table
4379
4380Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4381separate instruction and data caches.  Writing into a stack location
4382fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4383jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4384
4385Here are two possible solutions.  One is to clear the relevant parts of
4386the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up.  The other is to
4387make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4388subroutine.  The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4389latter makes initialization faster.
4390
4391To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4392the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4393
4394@table @code
4395@findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4396@item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4397The total size in bytes of the cache.
4398
4399@findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4400@item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4401The length in bytes of each cache line.  The cache is divided into cache
4402lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4403fetched from memory.  Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4404entire line is read at once.  The data loaded into a cache line is
4405always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4406
4407@findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4408@item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4409The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4410location.
4411@end table
4412
4413Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4414the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4415
4416@table @code
4417@findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4418@item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4419If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4420cache} in the specified interval.  If it is not defined, and the macro
4421@code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4422cache.  The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4423@code{asm} statements.  Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4424expressions.
4425@end table
4426
4427To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro.  In addition,
4428you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4429cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4430beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4431its cache line.  Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4432
4433@table @code
4434@findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4435@item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4436Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4437work.  The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4438which will be compiled with GCC@.  They go in a library function named
4439@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4440
4441If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4442C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4443special label of your own in the assembler code.  Use one @code{asm}
4444statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4445global.  Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4446special assembler code.
4447@end table
4448
4449@node Library Calls
4450@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4451@cindex library subroutine names
4452@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4453
4454@c prevent bad page break with this line
4455Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4456
4457@table @code
4458@findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4459@item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4460A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4461multiplication of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not
4462define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4463a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4464
4465@findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4466@item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4467A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4468division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do not define
4469this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4470function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4471
4472@findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4473@item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4474A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4475division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4476this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4477function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4478
4479@findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4480@item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4481A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4482remainder in division of one signed full-word by another.  If you do
4483not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4484@code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4485
4486@findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4487@item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4488A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4489remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4490not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4491@code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4492
4493@findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4494@item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4495A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4496multiplication of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not
4497define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4498a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4499
4500@findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4501@item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4502A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4503division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do not define
4504this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4505function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4506
4507@findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4508@item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4509A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4510division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do not define
4511this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4512function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4513
4514@findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4515@item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4516A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4517remainder in division of one signed double-word by another.  If you do
4518not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4519@code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4520
4521@findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4522@item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4523A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4524remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another.  If you do
4525not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4526@code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4527
4528@findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4529@item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4530Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4531routines renames existing ones.  @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4532initializing all the normal library routines.
4533
4534@findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4535@item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4536Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4537the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4538value that indicates the result of the comparison.  It should return
4539zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4540
4541Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4542
4543@findex TARGET_EDOM
4544@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4545@item TARGET_EDOM
4546The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4547expression.  If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4548deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly.  Look in
4549@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4550system.
4551
4552If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4553domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4554error.  If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4555there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4556that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4557
4558@findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4559@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4560@item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4561Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4562refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}.  (On certain systems,
4563@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.)  If you don't define this
4564macro, a reasonable default is used.
4565
4566@findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4567@cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4568@cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4569@cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4570@cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4571@cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4572@item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4573Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4574(and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4575@code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4576
4577@findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4578@item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4579Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4580routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}).  This macro
4581affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4582routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments.  It is useful on
4583machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4584differently, such as the i860.
4585
4586@findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4587@item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4588Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4589the calling convention of the NeXT system.  This calling convention
4590involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4591at once to the method-lookup library function.
4592
4593The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4594to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4595@end table
4596
4597@node Addressing Modes
4598@section Addressing Modes
4599@cindex addressing modes
4600
4601@c prevent bad page break with this line
4602This is about addressing modes.
4603
4604@table @code
4605@findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4606@findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4607@findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4608@findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4609@item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4610@itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4611@itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4612@itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4613A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4614pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4615
4616@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4617@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4618@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4619@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4620A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4621post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4622the size of the memory operand.
4623
4624@findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4625@findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4626@item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4627@itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4628A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4629post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4630
4631@findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4632@item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4633A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4634is a valid address.  On most machines, this can be defined as
4635@code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4636in which constant addresses are supported.
4637
4638@findex CONSTANT_P
4639@code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4640not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4641@code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4642addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4643
4644@findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4645@item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4646A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4647memory address.  Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4648the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4649accept.
4650
4651@findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4652@item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4653A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4654executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4655target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4656
4657It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4658subroutines for this one.  Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4659understand.
4660
4661This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4662non-strict one.  The strict variant is used in the reload pass.  It
4663must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4664allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference.  In
4665contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4666with no hard register must be rejected.
4667
4668The non-strict variant is used in other passes.  It must be defined to
4669accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4670register is required.
4671
4672@findex REG_OK_STRICT
4673Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4674macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}.  You should use an
4675@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4676in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4677
4678Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4679for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4680among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4681Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4682levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4683
4684Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4685and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4686constant.  Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4687specifically as legitimate addresses.  Normally you would simply
4688recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4689
4690Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4691sums that are not marked with  @code{const}.  It assumes that a naked
4692@code{plus} indicates indexing.  If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4693naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4694be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4695
4696@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4697On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4698the section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the
4699macro @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
4700@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  When you see a
4701@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4702@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section.  @xref{Assembler
4703Format}.
4704
4705@findex saveable_obstack
4706The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4707beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity.  Allocate
4708the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}.  You will have to modify
4709@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4710output the name accordingly, and define @code{STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} to
4711access the original name string.
4712
4713You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4714the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4715@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4716
4717@findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4718@item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4719A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4720RTX) is valid for use as a base register.  For hard registers, it
4721should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4722others.  Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4723controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above.  This usually
4724requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4725controls the one actually used.
4726
4727@findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4728@item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4729A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4730that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4731@var{mode}.  You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4732reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register.  If
4733you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4734@code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4735
4736@findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4737@item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4738A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4739RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4740
4741The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4742the index register may be scaled.  If an address involves the sum of
4743two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4744labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4745labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4746may serve in each capacity.  The compiler will try both labelings,
4747looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4748only if neither labeling works.
4749
4750@findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4751@item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4752A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4753This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4754
4755It is always safe for this macro to not be defined.  It exists so
4756that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4757
4758The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4759a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4760
4761@findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4762@item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4763A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4764memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a
4765C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4766
4767@example
4768GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4769@end example
4770
4771@noindent
4772to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
4773
4774@findex break_out_memory_refs
4775@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
4776and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
4777@var{x}.
4778
4779The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
4780@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4781should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4782
4783It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4784address.  The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases.  In
4785fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing.  But often a
4786machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4787
4788@findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
4789@item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
4790A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
4791that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
4792@var{mode}.  @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
4793It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
4794performance reasons.
4795
4796For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
4797reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
4798registers into a register.  On the other hand, for number of RISC
4799processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
4800needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot.  By defining
4801@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
4802generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
4803be shared.
4804
4805@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution.  It is necessary
4806to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
4807and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
4808of reload internals.
4809
4810@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
4811previous invocation of this macro.  If it fails to handle such addresses
4812then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
4813
4814@findex push_reload
4815The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
4816need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
4817suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
4818
4819The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
4820@var{x}.  If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
4821should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
4822This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
4823@code{push_reload}.
4824
4825@findex strict_memory_address_p
4826The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
4827the address has become legitimate.
4828
4829@findex copy_rtx
4830If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
4831this is to use @code{copy_rtx}.  Note, however, that is unshares only a
4832single level of rtl.  Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
4833top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
4834It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
4835address;  but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
4836
4837@findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
4838@item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
4839A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
4840@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
4841different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
4842reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
4843but not others.
4844
4845Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
4846effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
4847of the operand being addressed.  Some machines have other mode-dependent
4848addresses.  Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
4849
4850You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
4851
4852@findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
4853@item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
4854A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
4855an immediate operand on the target machine.  You can assume that
4856@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.  In fact,
4857@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
4858anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
4859@end table
4860
4861@node Condition Code
4862@section Condition Code Status
4863@cindex condition code status
4864
4865@c prevent bad page break with this line
4866This describes the condition code status.
4867
4868@findex cc_status
4869The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
4870describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
4871the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by).  This
4872variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
4873currently based, and several standard flags.
4874
4875Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
4876description header file.  It can also add additional machine-specific
4877information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
4878
4879@table @code
4880@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
4881@item CC_STATUS_MDEP
4882C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
4883component of @code{cc_status}.  It defaults to @code{int}.
4884
4885This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4886
4887@findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4888@item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
4889A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
4890The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
4891the field anyway.  If you want to use the field, you should probably
4892define this macro to initialize it.
4893
4894This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4895
4896@findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
4897@item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
4898A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
4899appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}.  It is
4900this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
4901code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
4902set @code{(cc0)}.
4903
4904This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
4905
4906If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
4907other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
4908invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
4909reflecting.  For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
4910registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
4911@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
4912insns.  But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
4913based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
4914value in @samp{a4}.  Although the condition code is not changed by
4915this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
4916@samp{a4@@(102)}.  Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
4917@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
4918condition code value.
4919
4920The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
4921with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
4922@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
4923constants which are just the operands.  The RTL structure of these
4924insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do.  What
4925@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
4926@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
4927
4928A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
4929that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
4930@samp{cc}.  This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
4931two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
4932
4933@findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
4934@item EXTRA_CC_MODES
4935A list of additional modes for condition code values in registers
4936(@pxref{Jump Patterns}).  This macro should expand to a sequence of
4937calls of the macro @code{CC} separated by white space.  @code{CC} takes
4938two arguments.  The first is the enumeration name of the mode, which
4939should begin with @samp{CC} and end with @samp{mode}.  The second is a C
4940string giving the printable name of the mode; it should be the same as
4941the first argument, but with the trailing @samp{mode} removed.
4942
4943You should only define this macro if additional modes are required.
4944
4945A sample definition of @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is:
4946@smallexample
4947#define EXTRA_CC_MODES            \
4948    CC(CC_NOOVmode, "CC_NOOV")    \
4949    CC(CCFPmode, "CCFP")          \
4950    CC(CCFPEmode, "CCFPE")
4951@end smallexample
4952
4953@findex SELECT_CC_MODE
4954@item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
4955Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
4956operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}.  For
4957example, on the Sparc, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
4958@pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
4959definition)
4960
4961@smallexample
4962#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
4963  (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT          \
4964   ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode)    \
4965   : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS    \
4966       || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
4967      ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
4968@end smallexample
4969
4970You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
4971
4972@findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
4973@item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
4974On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
4975convert an invalid comparison into a valid one.  For example, the Alpha
4976does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
4977comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
4978
4979On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
4980required conversions.  @var{code} is the initial comparison code
4981and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
4982comparison, respectively.  You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
4983@var{op1} as required.
4984
4985GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
4986valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
4987@file{md} file.
4988
4989You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
4990code or operands.
4991
4992@findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
4993@item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
4994A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
4995comparison whose mode is @var{mode}.  If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
4996can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
4997then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
4998
4999You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5000floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5001For example, here is the definition used on the Sparc, where floating-point
5002inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5003
5004@smallexample
5005#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE)  ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5006@end smallexample
5007
5008@findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5009A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5010comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}.  The macro is used only in case
5011@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero.  Define this macro in case
5012machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals.  For
5013instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5014freely convert unordered compares to ordered one.  Then definition may look
5015like:
5016
5017@smallexample
5018#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5019   ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5020    : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5021@end smallexample
5022
5023@findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5024@item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5025A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5026@var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa.  Define this to
5027return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5028reversed safely.  If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5029follows:
5030
5031@smallexample
5032#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5033   ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5034@end smallexample
5035
5036@end table
5037
5038@node Costs
5039@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5040@cindex costs of instructions
5041@cindex relative costs
5042@cindex speed of instructions
5043
5044These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5045on the target machine.
5046
5047@table @code
5048@findex CONST_COSTS
5049@item CONST_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5050A part of a C @code{switch} statement that describes the relative costs
5051of constant RTL expressions.  It must contain @code{case} labels for
5052expression codes @code{const_int}, @code{const}, @code{symbol_ref},
5053@code{label_ref} and @code{const_double}.  Each case must ultimately
5054reach a @code{return} statement to return the relative cost of the use
5055of that kind of constant value in an expression.  The cost may depend on
5056the precise value of the constant, which is available for examination in
5057@var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression in which it is contained,
5058found in @var{outer_code}.
5059
5060@var{code} is the expression code---redundant, since it can be
5061obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5062
5063@findex RTX_COSTS
5064@findex COSTS_N_INSNS
5065@item RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5066Like @code{CONST_COSTS} but applies to nonconstant RTL expressions.
5067This can be used, for example, to indicate how costly a multiply
5068instruction is.  In writing this macro, you can use the construct
5069@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5070instructions.  @var{outer_code} is the code of the expression in which
5071@var{x} is contained.
5072
5073This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5074are adequate for the target machine.
5075
5076@findex DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS
5077@item DEFAULT_RTX_COSTS (@var{x}, @var{code}, @var{outer_code})
5078This macro, if defined, is called for any case not handled by the
5079@code{RTX_COSTS} or @code{CONST_COSTS} macros.  This eliminates the need
5080to put case labels into the macro, but the code, or any functions it
5081calls, must assume that the RTL in @var{x} could be of any type that has
5082not already been handled.  The arguments are the same as for
5083@code{RTX_COSTS}, and the macro should execute a return statement giving
5084the cost of any RTL expressions that it can handle.  The default cost
5085calculation is used for any RTL for which this macro does not return a
5086value.
5087
5088This macro is optional; do not define it if the default cost assumptions
5089are adequate for the target machine.
5090
5091@findex ADDRESS_COST
5092@item ADDRESS_COST (@var{address})
5093An expression giving the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5094@var{address}.  If not defined, the cost is computed from
5095the @var{address} expression and the @code{CONST_COSTS} values.
5096
5097For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5098true cost of the addressing mode.  However, on RISC machines, all
5099instructions normally have the same length and execution time.  Hence
5100all addresses will have equal costs.
5101
5102In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5103the lowest cost will be used.  If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5104cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5105
5106For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5107and a constant is used twice in the same basic block.  When this macro
5108is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5109references will be indirect through that register.  On machines where
5110the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5111that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5112instruction and possibly require an additional register.  Proper
5113specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5114
5115Similar use of this macro is made in strength reduction of loops.
5116
5117@var{address} need not be valid as an address.  In such a case, the cost
5118is not relevant and can be any value; invalid addresses need not be
5119assigned a different cost.
5120
5121On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5122cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5123@code{ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to be live
5124over a region of code where only one would have been if
5125@code{ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner.  This effect should
5126be considered in the definition of this macro.  Equivalent costs should
5127probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of registers
5128on machines with lots of registers.
5129
5130This macro will normally either not be defined or be defined as a
5131constant.
5132
5133@findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5134@item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5135A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5136register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}.  The classes are
5137expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.  A
5138value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5139that.
5140
5141It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5142same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5143registers if they are not general registers.
5144
5145If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5146hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5147classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5148constraints of the insn are met.  Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5149allow reload to verify that the constraints are met.  You should do this
5150if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5151
5152@findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5153@item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5154A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5155register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5156is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in.  This cost
5157is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.  If moving between
5158registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5159should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5160
5161If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5162the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5163needed.  If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5164between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5165more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5166reflect the actual cost of the move.
5167
5168GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5169secondary reloads are needed.  It computes the costs due to copying via
5170a secondary register.  If your machine copies from memory using a
5171secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
51724 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5173value to the result of that function.  The arguments to that function
5174are the same as to this macro.
5175
5176@findex BRANCH_COST
5177@item BRANCH_COST
5178A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction.  A value of 1 is
5179the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5180@end table
5181
5182Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5183but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5184ordinarily expect.
5185
5186@table @code
5187@findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5188@item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5189Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5190than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5191faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5192require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5193between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5194
5195When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5196finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5197load will be used if alignment permits.  Unless bytes accesses are
5198faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5199may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5200other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5201
5202@findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5203@item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5204Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5205@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5206than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5207handler.
5208
5209When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5210@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5211moves.  This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5212Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5213cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5214
5215If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined.  If
5216this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5217@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5218
5219@findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5220@item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5221Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5222(On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5223than good.)
5224
5225@findex MOVE_RATIO
5226@item MOVE_RATIO
5227The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5228which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5229string move insn or a library call.  Increasing the value will always
5230make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5231
5232Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5233@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5234the number of such sequences.
5235
5236If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5237
5238@findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5239@item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5240A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5241copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5242will be used.  Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5243than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5244
5245@findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5246@item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5247A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5248a load or store used to copy memory is.  Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5249
5250@findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5251@item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5252A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5253thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5254@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5255
5256@findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5257@item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5258A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5259thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5260@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5261
5262@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5263@item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5264A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5265thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5266@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5267
5268@findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5269@item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5270A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5271thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5272@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5273
5274@findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5275@item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5276A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5277thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5278@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5279
5280@findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5281@item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5282A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5283thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5284@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5285
5286@findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5287@item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5288This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5289thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5290@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5291
5292@findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5293@item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5294This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5295thing to use for a given mode.  Defaults to the value of
5296@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5297
5298@findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5299@item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5300Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5301function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5302
5303@findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5304@item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5305Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5306itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5307register.
5308@end table
5309
5310@node Scheduling
5311@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5312
5313The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5314adjustment in order to produce good code.  GCC provides several target
5315hooks for this purpose.  It is usually enough to define just a few of
5316them: try the first ones in this list first.
5317
5318@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5319This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever issue
5320at the same time on the target machine.  The default is one.  This value
5321must be constant over the entire compilation.  If you need it to vary
5322depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5323@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5324@end deftypefn
5325
5326@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5327This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5328from the ready list.  It should return the number of insns which can
5329still be issued in the current cycle.  Normally this is
5330@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}}.  You should define this hook if some insns
5331take more machine resources than others, so that fewer insns can follow
5332them in the same cycle.  @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio
5333stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level
5334provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{insn} is the
5335instruction that was scheduled.
5336@end deftypefn
5337
5338@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5339This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the relationship
5340between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the dependence @var{link}.
5341It should return the new value.  The default is to make no adjustment to
5342@var{cost}.  This can be used for example to specify to the scheduler
5343that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5344data-dependence.
5345@end deftypefn
5346
5347@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5348This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5349@var{insn}.  It should return the new priority.  Reduce the priority to
5350execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5351later.  Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5352scheduling priorities of insns.
5353@end deftypefn
5354
5355@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5356This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5357list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5358combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5359@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5360debug output to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5361@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.  @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5362list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled.  @var{n_readyp} is
5363a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list.  The scheduler
5364reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5365@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0].  @var{clock}
5366is the timer tick of the scheduler.  You may modify the ready list and
5367the number of ready insns.  The return value is the number of insns that
5368can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}.  See also
5369@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5370@end deftypefn
5371
5372@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5373Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time.  That
5374function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle.  This one
5375is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5376@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5377return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle.  Defining
5378this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5379scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5380cycle.  These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5381@end deftypefn
5382
5383@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5384This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5385instructions that are to be scheduled.  @var{file} is either a null
5386pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.  @var{verbose}
5387is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5388@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5389region that can be live at the same time.  This can be used to allocate
5390scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5391@end deftypefn
5392
5393@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5394This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5395instructions that are to be scheduled.  It can be used to perform
5396cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks.  @var{file}
5397is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5398to.  @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5399@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5400@end deftypefn
5401
5402@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_CYCLE_DISPLAY (int @var{clock}, rtx @var{last})
5403This hook is called in verbose mode only, at the beginning of each pass
5404over a basic block.  It should insert an insn into the chain after
5405@var{last}, which has no effect, but records the value @var{clock} in
5406RTL dumps and assembly output.  Define this hook only if you need this
5407level of detail about what the scheduler is doing.
5408@end deftypefn
5409
5410@node Sections
5411@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5412@c the above section title is WAY too long.  maybe cut the part between
5413@c the (...)?  --mew 10feb93
5414
5415An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5416data.  In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5417section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5418section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5419section}, which holds uninitialized data.  Some systems have other kinds
5420of sections.
5421
5422The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections.  These
5423macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this.  You
5424can also define additional sections.
5425
5426@table @code
5427@findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5428@item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5429A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5430assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5431Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5432
5433@findex TEXT_SECTION
5434@item TEXT_SECTION
5435A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5436Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5437is enough.  The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5438declarations.
5439
5440@findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5441@item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5442A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5443assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5444data.  Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5445
5446@findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5447@item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5448If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5449containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5450shared data.  If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5451
5452@findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5453@item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5454If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5455containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5456uninitialized global data.  If not defined, and neither
5457@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5458uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5459@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5460used.
5461
5462@findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5463@item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5464If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5465containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5466uninitialized global shared data.  If not defined, and
5467@code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5468
5469@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5470@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5471If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5472containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5473initialization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5474not exist.
5475
5476@findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5477@item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5478If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5479containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5480finalization code.  If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5481not exist.
5482
5483@findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5484@item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5485If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5486via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5487the text section.  This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5488@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5489to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5490sections.  By default, this macro uses a simple function call.  Some
5491ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5492registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5493constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5494
5495@findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5496@item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5497If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5498arbitrary boundary.  This is used to force all fragments of the
5499@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5500and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5501
5502@findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5503@findex in_text
5504@findex in_data
5505@item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5506A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5507@code{in_text} and @code{in_data}.  You need not define this macro
5508on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5509
5510@findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5511@findex text_section
5512@findex data_section
5513@item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5514One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}.  These
5515functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5516@code{data_section}, for your additional sections.  Do not define this
5517macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5518
5519@findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5520@item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5521On most machines, read-only variables, constants, and jump tables are
5522placed in the text section.  If this is not the case on your machine,
5523this macro should be defined to be the name of a function (either
5524@code{data_section} or a function defined in @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}) that
5525switches to the section to be used for read-only items.
5526
5527If these items should be placed in the text section, this macro should
5528not be defined.
5529
5530@findex SELECT_SECTION
5531@item SELECT_SECTION (@var{exp}, @var{reloc}, @var{align})
5532A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5533output of @var{exp}.  You can assume that @var{exp} is either a
5534@code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of some sort.  @var{reloc}
5535indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time
5536relocations.  Bit 1 is set when variable contains local relocations
5537only, while bit 2 is set for global relocations.
5538Select the section by calling @code{text_section} or one
5539of the alternatives for other sections.  @var{align} is the constant
5540alignment in bits.
5541
5542Do not define this macro if you put all read-only variables and
5543constants in the read-only data section (usually the text section).
5544
5545@findex SELECT_RTX_SECTION
5546@item SELECT_RTX_SECTION (@var{mode}, @var{rtx}, @var{align})
5547A C statement or statements to switch to the appropriate section for
5548output of @var{rtx} in mode @var{mode}.  You can assume that @var{rtx}
5549is some kind of constant in RTL@.  The argument @var{mode} is redundant
5550except in the case of a @code{const_int} rtx.  Select the section by
5551calling @code{text_section} or one of the alternatives for other
5552sections.  @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
5553
5554Do not define this macro if you put all constants in the read-only
5555data section.
5556
5557@findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5558@item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5559Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5560tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5561section, along with the assembler instructions.  Otherwise, the
5562readonly data section is used.
5563
5564This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5565
5566@findex ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
5567@item ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (@var{decl})
5568Define this macro if references to a symbol or a constant must be
5569treated differently depending on something about the variable or
5570function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
5571
5572The macro definition, if any, is executed under two circumstances.  One
5573is immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable
5574or a function has been created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL
5575(@var{decl})}.  The value of the rtl will be a @code{mem} whose address
5576is a @code{symbol_ref}.  The other is immediately after the rtl for
5577@var{decl} that represents a constant has been created and stored in
5578@code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}.  The macro is called once for each
5579distinct constant in a source file.
5580
5581@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
5582The usual thing for this macro to do is to record a flag in the
5583@code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
5584modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not enough
5585information).
5586
5587@findex STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
5588@item STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (@var{var}, @var{sym_name})
5589Decode @var{sym_name} and store the real name part in @var{var}, sans
5590the characters that encode section info.  Define this macro if
5591@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} alters the symbol's name string.
5592
5593@findex UNIQUE_SECTION
5594@item UNIQUE_SECTION (@var{decl}, @var{reloc})
5595A C statement to build up a unique section name, expressed as a
5596@code{STRING_CST} node, and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5597@var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp} requires
5598link-time relocations.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will use
5599the symbol name prefixed by @samp{.} as the section name.  Note - this
5600macro can now be called for uninitialized data items as well as
5601initialized data and functions.
5602@end table
5603
5604@node PIC
5605@section Position Independent Code
5606@cindex position independent code
5607@cindex PIC
5608
5609This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
5610independent code.  Simply defining these macros is not enough to
5611generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
5612@code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
5613well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}.  You must modify the definition of
5614@samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
5615contains a symbolic address.  You may also need to alter the handling of
5616switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
5617@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
5618@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
5619
5620@table @code
5621@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5622@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
5623The register number of the register used to address a table of static
5624data addresses in memory.  In some cases this register is defined by a
5625processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@.  When this macro
5626is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
5627pointer and frame pointer registers.  If this macro is not defined, it
5628is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
5629necessary).  Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
5630when @code{flag_pic} is true).
5631
5632@findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5633@item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
5634Define this macro if the register defined by
5635@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls.  Do not define
5636this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
5637
5638@findex FINALIZE_PIC
5639@item FINALIZE_PIC
5640By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
5641and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
5642shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
5643programs.  In some of these environments, position-independent code
5644requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
5645special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
5646
5647The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
5648codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
5649before.  (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
5650inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
5651included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
5652assembly language.)
5653
5654@findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
5655@item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
5656A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
5657operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
5658You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
5659check this.  You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
5660check it either.  You need not define this macro if all constants
5661(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
5662position independent code.
5663@end table
5664
5665@node Assembler Format
5666@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
5667
5668This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
5669to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
5670instructions do.
5671
5672@menu
5673* File Framework::       Structural information for the assembler file.
5674* Data Output::          Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
5675* Uninitialized Data::   Output of uninitialized variables.
5676* Label Output::         Output and generation of labels.
5677* Initialization::       General principles of initialization
5678			   and termination routines.
5679* Macros for Initialization::
5680			 Specific macros that control the handling of
5681			   initialization and termination routines.
5682* Instruction Output::   Output of actual instructions.
5683* Dispatch Tables::      Output of jump tables.
5684* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
5685* Alignment Output::     Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
5686@end menu
5687
5688@node File Framework
5689@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
5690@cindex assembler format
5691@cindex output of assembler code
5692
5693@c prevent bad page break with this line
5694This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
5695
5696@table @code
5697@findex ASM_FILE_START
5698@item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
5699A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5700some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
5701
5702Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
5703@samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5704assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
5705checking for certain assembler constructs.
5706
5707On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5708see @file{attasm.h}.
5709
5710@findex ASM_FILE_END
5711@item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
5712A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
5713some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
5714
5715If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
5716special at the end of the file.  Most systems don't require any
5717definition.
5718
5719On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
5720see @file{attasm.h}.
5721
5722@findex ASM_COMMENT_START
5723@item ASM_COMMENT_START
5724A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
5725assembler language.  The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
5726the end of the line.
5727
5728@findex ASM_APP_ON
5729@item ASM_APP_ON
5730A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
5731statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5732@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
5733assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
5734that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
5735
5736@findex ASM_APP_OFF
5737@item ASM_APP_OFF
5738A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
5739statement or group of consecutive ones.  Normally this is
5740@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
5741time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
5742
5743@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
5744@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
5745A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
5746which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
5747the stdio stream @var{stream}.
5748
5749This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
5750for the file format in use is appropriate.
5751
5752@findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
5753@item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5754A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
5755@var{stream}.  If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
5756in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
5757the assembler source.  So you can use it to canonicalize the format
5758of the filename using this macro.
5759
5760@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
5761@item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
5762A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
5763for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
5764stdio stream @var{stream}.
5765
5766This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
5767information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
5768
5769@findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
5770@item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
5771A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
5772@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}.  If this
5773macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
5774
5775@findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
5776@item OBJC_PROLOGUE
5777A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
5778precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending.  The
5779statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
5780@end table
5781
5782@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
5783Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}.  The section
5784should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
5785of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}.  If @var{align}
5786is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
5787otherwise some target default should be used.  Only targets that must
5788specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
5789@var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
5790@end deftypefn
5791
5792@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
5793This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
5794@end deftypefn
5795
5796@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
5797Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
5798based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
5799declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations.  @var{decl} may be
5800 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
5801
5802The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
5803read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}.  You should only
5804need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
5805set via @code{__attribute__}.
5806@end deftypefn
5807
5808@need 2000
5809@node Data Output
5810@subsection Output of Data
5811
5812
5813@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
5814@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
5815@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
5816@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
5817@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
5818@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
5819@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
5820@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
5821@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
5822These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
5823of integer object.  The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
5824byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
5825aligned two-byte object, and so on.  Any of the hooks may be
5826@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
5827
5828The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
5829followed immediately by the object's initial value.  In most cases,
5830the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
5831@end deftypevr
5832
5833@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
5834The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
5835integer object.  @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
5836in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned.  The
5837function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
5838object.  If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
5839split the object into smaller parts.
5840
5841The default implementation of this hook will use the
5842@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
5843when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
5844@end deftypefn
5845
5846@table @code
5847@findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
5848@item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
5849A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
5850@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
5851@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}.  This may be used to
5852allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
5853
5854If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
5855@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed.  If it
5856prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
5857@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
5858
5859@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
5860@item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
5861A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
5862instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
5863bytes at @var{ptr}.  @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
5864@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
5865
5866If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
5867Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
5868@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
5869
5870@findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
5871@item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
5872A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
5873@var{decl}.  This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
5874is defined, and is otherwise unused.
5875
5876@findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5877@item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
5878You may define this macro as a C expression.  You should define the
5879expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
5880pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
5881GCC should output the constant pool after the function.  If you do
5882not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
5883pool before the function.
5884
5885@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
5886@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
5887A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
5888constant pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving
5889the name of the function.  Should the return type of the function
5890be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size}
5891is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
5892immediately after this call.
5893
5894If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
5895not be defined.
5896
5897@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
5898@item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
5899A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
5900constant pool, if it needs special treatment.  (This macro need not do
5901anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
5902
5903The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
5904assembler code on.  @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
5905output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
5906@samp{const_int}).  @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
5907@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
5908alignment.
5909
5910The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
5911the address of this pool entry.  The definition of this macro is
5912responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
5913Here is how to do this:
5914
5915@example
5916ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
5917@end example
5918
5919When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
5920@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}.  This will prevent the same pool
5921entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
5922
5923You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
5924
5925@findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
5926@item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
5927Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
5928@var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
5929function.  The compiler will normally output all constants before the
5930function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
5931
5932@findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
5933@item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
5934A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
5935pool for a function.  @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
5936function.  Should the return type of the function be required, you can
5937obtain it via @var{fundecl}.  @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
5938constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
5939
5940If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
5941define this macro.
5942
5943@findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
5944@item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
5945Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
5946used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
5947
5948If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
5949the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
5950@end table
5951
5952@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
5953@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
5954These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
5955assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions.  If not overridden, they
5956default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
5957@end deftypevr
5958
5959  These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
5960of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
5961
5962@table @code
5963@item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5964@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5965@itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
5966@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
5967@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
5968@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
5969These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
5970floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the array of
5971@code{long int} whose address is @var{l}.  The number of elements in the
5972output array is determined by the size of the desired target floating
5973point data type: 32 bits of it go in each @code{long int} array
5974element.  Each array element holds 32 bits of the result, even if
5975@code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the host machine.
5976
5977The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
5978using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
5979machine's memory.
5980
5981@item REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL (@var{x}, @var{format}, @var{string})
5982@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_DECIMAL
5983This macro converts @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to a
5984decimal number and stores it as a string into @var{string}.
5985You must pass, as @var{string}, the address of a long enough block
5986of space to hold the result.
5987
5988The argument @var{format} is a @code{printf}-specification that serves
5989as a suggestion for how to format the output string.
5990@end table
5991
5992@node Uninitialized Data
5993@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
5994
5995Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
5996outputting a single uninitialized variable.
5997
5998@table @code
5999@findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
6000@item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6001A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6002@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6003@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6004is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6005
6006Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6007output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6008assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6009
6010This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6011common global variables are output.
6012
6013@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6014@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6015Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6016separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6017place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6018handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6019as the number of bits.
6020
6021@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6022@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6023Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6024variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6025is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6026in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6027@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6028the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6029
6030@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6031@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6032If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6033is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6034will be used.
6035
6036@findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6037@item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6038A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6039@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6040@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6041is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6042
6043Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6044defining this macro.  If unable, use the expression
6045@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6046before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6047the name, and a newline.
6048
6049This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6050variables are output.  This macro exists to properly support languages like
6051C++ which do not have @code{common} data.  However, this macro currently
6052is not defined for all targets.  If this macro and
6053@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6054or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6055@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6056
6057@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6058@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6059Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6060separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6061place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6062handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6063as the number of bits.
6064
6065Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6066@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6067
6068@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6069@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6070If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6071is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6072will be used.
6073
6074@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6075@item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6076A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6077@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6078@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes.  The variable @var{rounded}
6079is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6080
6081Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6082output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6083assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6084
6085This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6086static variables are output.
6087
6088@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6089@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6090Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6091separate, explicit argument.  If you define this macro, it is used in
6092place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6093handling the required alignment of the variable.  The alignment is specified
6094as the number of bits.
6095
6096@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6097@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6098Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6099variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6100is no corresponding variable.  If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6101in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6102@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}.  Define this macro when you need to see
6103the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6104
6105@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6106@item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6107If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6108is used when @var{name} is shared.  If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6109will be used.
6110@end table
6111
6112@node Label Output
6113@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6114
6115@c prevent bad page break with this line
6116This is about outputting labels.
6117
6118@table @code
6119@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6120@findex assemble_name
6121@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6122A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6123@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6124Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6125output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6126assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6127
6128@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6129@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6130A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6131@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6132function which is being defined.  This macro is responsible for
6133outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6134@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument @var{decl} is the
6135@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6136
6137If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6138usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6139
6140@findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6141@item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6142A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6143@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6144which is being defined.  The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6145function.  The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6146representing the function.
6147
6148If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6149
6150@findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6151@item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6152A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6153@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6154initialized variable which is being defined.  This macro must output the
6155label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).  The argument
6156@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6157
6158If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6159usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6160
6161@findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6162@item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6163A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6164@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6165for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6166
6167If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6168nothing.
6169
6170@findex  ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6171@item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6172A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6173once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6174chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6175initializer.  This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6176something about the size of the object.
6177
6178If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6179nothing.
6180
6181@findex ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
6182@item ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6183A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6184@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6185that is, available for reference from other files.  Use the expression
6186@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6187itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6188for making that name global, and a newline.
6189
6190@findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6191@item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6192A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6193@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6194that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6195no other definition is available.  Use the expression
6196@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6197itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6198for making that name weak, and a newline.
6199
6200If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
6201support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
6202macro.
6203
6204@findex ASM_WEAKEN_DECL
6205@item ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6206Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
6207@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
6208or variable decl.  If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
6209should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
6210defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6211@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
6212to make @var{name} weak.
6213
6214@findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6215@item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6216A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6217
6218If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6219definition.  If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
6220is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
6221@samp{0}.  Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
6222with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
6223
6224@findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6225@item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6226A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6227public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6228be discarded by the linker.  Define this macro if your object file
6229format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6230section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6231requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6232
6233@findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6234@item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6235A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6236semantics.
6237
6238If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6239definition.  If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6240definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.  Define this macro if
6241you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6242setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6243be emitted as one-only.
6244
6245@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6246@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6247A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6248@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6249symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6250not defined.  The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6251declaration.
6252
6253This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6254The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6255
6256@findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6257@item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6258A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6259pseudo-op to declare a library function name external.  The name of the
6260library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6261is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6262
6263This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6264The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6265
6266@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6267@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6268A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6269@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6270@var{name}.  This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6271is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6272systems.  This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6273
6274@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6275@item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6276A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6277@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}.  If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6278will be used to output the name of the symbol.  This macro may be used
6279to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6280encoded by @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6281
6282@findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6283@item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6284A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6285result of ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.  If not defined,
6286@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6287This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6288specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6289when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address
6290is being taken.
6291
6292@findex ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL
6293@item ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6294A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6295name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6296
6297It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6298used for user-level functions and variables.  Otherwise, certain programs
6299will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6300
6301It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6302object file.  Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6303should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6304beginning of a label has this effect.  You should find out what
6305convention your system uses, and follow it.
6306
6307The usual definition of this macro is as follows:
6308
6309@example
6310fprintf (@var{stream}, "L%s%d:\n", @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6311@end example
6312
6313@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6314@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6315A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6316label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6317@var{num}.  This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6318may need to be treated differently than branch target labels.  On some
6319systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6320bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6321bundles.
6322
6323If this macro is not defined, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} will be
6324used.
6325
6326@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME
6327@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALTERNATE_LABEL_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6328A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} the string
6329@var{string}.
6330
6331The default definition of this macro is as follows:
6332
6333@example
6334fprintf (@var{stream}, "%s:\n", LABEL_ALTERNATE_NAME (INSN))
6335@end example
6336
6337@findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6338@item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6339A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6340is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6341
6342This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6343produce the output that @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL} would produce
6344with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6345
6346If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6347output the rest of the string unchanged.  It is often convenient for
6348@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way.  If the
6349string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6350to output the string, and may change it.  (Of course,
6351@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6352you should know what it does on your machine.)
6353
6354@findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6355@item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6356A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6357@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6358@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6359added.  Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6360
6361The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6362produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6363@var{name}.  Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6364assembler code.  The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6365macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6366internal static variables in different scopes.
6367
6368Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6369conflict with the user's own symbols.  Most assemblers allow periods
6370or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6371between the name and the number will suffice.
6372
6373@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6374@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6375A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6376which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6377
6378@findex SET_ASM_OP
6379If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6380correct for most systems.
6381
6382@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6383@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6384A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6385which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6386to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}.  This macro will
6387be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6388the tree nodes are available.
6389
6390@findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
6391@item ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL (@var{stream}, @var{symbol}, @var{high}, @var{low})
6392A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6393which defines (equates) the symbol @var{symbol} to have a value equal to
6394the difference of the two symbols @var{high} and @var{low},
6395i.e.@: @var{high} minus @var{low}.  GCC guarantees that the symbols @var{high}
6396and @var{low} are already known by the assembler so that the difference
6397resolves into a constant.
6398
6399@findex SET_ASM_OP
6400If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6401correct for most systems.
6402
6403@findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6404@item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6405A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6406which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6407@var{value}.  If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6408an undefined weak symbol.
6409
6410Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6411@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6412
6413@findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6414@item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6415Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6416Objective-C methods.
6417
6418The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6419class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}).  For methods in categories, the name of
6420the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6421@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6422
6423These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6424the method's selector is not present in the name.  Therefore, particular
6425systems define other ways of computing names.
6426
6427@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6428buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6429@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
643050 characters extra.
6431
6432The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6433method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6434@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6435in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6436
6437On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6438macro to provide more human-readable names.
6439
6440@findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6441@item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6442A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6443@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6444Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets whose
6445linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6446
6447@findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6448@item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6449A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6450@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6451unresolved Objective-C class reference.  This is only needed for targets
6452whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6453@end table
6454
6455@node Initialization
6456@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6457@cindex initialization routines
6458@cindex termination routines
6459@cindex constructors, output of
6460@cindex destructors, output of
6461
6462The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6463(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6464data in the program when the program is started.  These functions need
6465to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6466@code{main} is called.
6467
6468Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6469@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6470terminates.
6471
6472To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6473must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6474be called at the appropriate time.  When you port the compiler to a new
6475system, you need to specify how to do this.
6476
6477There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6478initialization and termination functions.  Each way has two variants.
6479Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
6480
6481@findex __CTOR_LIST__
6482@findex __DTOR_LIST__
6483The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
6484initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
6485termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
6486
6487Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
64880, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
6489the environment).  This is followed by a series of zero or more function
6490pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
6491pointer containing zero.
6492
6493Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
6494@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
6495time and exit time.  Constructors are called in reverse order of the
6496list; destructors in forward order.
6497
6498The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
6499formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections.  A section is set
6500aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
6501Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}.  Each
6502object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
6503the constructor section to point to that function.  The linker
6504accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
6505Termination functions are handled similarly.
6506
6507This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
6508@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined.  A target that does not
6509support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
6510constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6511and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
6512
6513When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
6514upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called.  On systems that
6515support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
6516parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section.  The
6517program is linked by the @code{gcc} driver like this:
6518
6519@example
6520ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
6521@end example
6522
6523The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
6524section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}.  Likewise
6525for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section.  Normally these
6526files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
6527are provided by GCC for a few targets.
6528
6529The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
6530compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}.  They contain, among other things, code
6531fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
6532to routines in the @code{.text} section.  The linker will pull all parts
6533of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
6534that invokes the routines we need at startup.
6535
6536To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
6537macro properly.
6538
6539If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
6540@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
6541entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
6542it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
6543after the function prologue.  The @code{__main} function is defined
6544in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
6545
6546In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
6547two variants.  In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
6548and an `a.out' format must be used.  In this case,
6549@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
6550entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
6551and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
6552code as its value.  The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
6553the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
6554placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
6555a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
6556@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly.  Since no init
6557section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
6558the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
6559the initialization process.
6560
6561The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
6562This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
6563file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@.  In
6564this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
6565termination functions are recognized simply by their names.  This requires
6566an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}.  This program
6567pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
6568the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
6569initialization and termination functions.  These functions are called
6570via @code{__main} as described above.  In order to use this method,
6571@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
6572
6573@ifinfo
6574The following section describes the specific macros that control and
6575customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
6576@end ifinfo
6577
6578@node Macros for Initialization
6579@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
6580
6581Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
6582and termination functions:
6583
6584@table @code
6585@findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6586@item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6587If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
6588operation to identify the following data as initialization code.  If not
6589defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist.  When you are
6590using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
6591macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
6592run the initialization functions.
6593
6594@item HAS_INIT_SECTION
6595@findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
6596If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
6597This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
6598on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
6599be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6600
6601@item LD_INIT_SWITCH
6602@findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
6603If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6604the following symbol is an initialization routine.
6605
6606@item LD_FINI_SWITCH
6607@findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
6608If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
6609the following symbol is a finalization routine.
6610
6611@item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6612If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6613automatically called when a shared library is loaded.  The function
6614should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6615the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
6616function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
6617
6618This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
6619shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
6620exception tables embedded in the code.
6621
6622@item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
6623If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
6624automatically called when a shared library is unloaded.  The function
6625should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments.  If not defined, and
6626the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
6627function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
6628
6629@item INVOKE__main
6630@findex INVOKE__main
6631If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
6632@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.  This macro should be defined for systems
6633where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
6634useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
6635
6636@item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6637@findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
6638If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
6639compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
6640of objects.  If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
6641encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
6642@end table
6643
6644@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
6645This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
6646collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
6647It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
6648@end deftypefn
6649
6650@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6651If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
6652the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
6653
6654Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
6655no arguments and with no return value.  If the target supports initialization
6656priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
6657otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
6658
6659If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
6660be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
6661target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
6662is not defined.
6663@end deftypefn
6664
6665@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
6666This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
6667functions rather than initialization functions.
6668@end deftypefn
6669
6670If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
6671generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
6672
6673If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
6674constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
6675an object file for constructor functions to be called.
6676
6677On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
6678@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
6679
6680@table @code
6681@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6682@item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
6683Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
6684object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
6685object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6686
6687@findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6688@item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
6689Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
6690@command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
6691for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
6692
6693These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
6694part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
6695
6696@findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6697@item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
6698Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
6699to execute @command{nm}.  The default is to search the path normally for
6700@command{nm}.
6701
6702If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
6703dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
6704these macros to enable support for running initialization and
6705termination functions in shared libraries:
6706
6707@findex LDD_SUFFIX
6708@item LDD_SUFFIX
6709Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
6710which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
6711
6712@findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
6713@item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
6714Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
6715of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  @var{ptr} is a variable
6716of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
6717from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}.  If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
6718code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
6719line.  Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
6720@end table
6721
6722@node Instruction Output
6723@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
6724
6725@c prevent bad page break with this line
6726This describes assembler instruction output.
6727
6728@table @code
6729@findex REGISTER_NAMES
6730@item REGISTER_NAMES
6731A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
6732registers, each one as a C string constant.  This is what translates
6733register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
6734
6735@findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6736@item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
6737If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
6738and a register number.  This macro defines additional names for hard
6739registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
6740to registers using alternate names.
6741
6742@findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
6743@item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
6744Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
6745requires different names for the machine instructions.
6746
6747The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
6748assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}.  The
6749macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
6750points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
6751written in the machine description.  The definition should output the
6752opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
6753increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
6754so that it will not be output twice.
6755
6756In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
6757name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
6758that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
6759care of the substitution yourself.  Just be sure to increment
6760@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
6761
6762@findex recog_data.operand
6763If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
6764elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
6765
6766If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
6767in the usual way.
6768
6769@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
6770@item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
6771If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
6772assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
6773they will be output differently.
6774
6775Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
6776extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
6777elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
6778The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
6779template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
6780by changing the contents of the vector.
6781
6782This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
6783file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
6784can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
6785as with rearranged operands).  Naturally, variations in assembler
6786syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
6787writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
6788
6789If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
6790
6791@findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6792@item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
6793If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
6794@code{CODE_LABEL}.  In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
6795@var{noperands} will be zero.
6796
6797@findex PRINT_OPERAND
6798@item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
6799A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6800assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}.  @var{x} is an
6801RTL expression.
6802
6803@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
6804of printing the operand.  It is used when identical operands must be
6805printed differently depending on the context.  @var{code} comes from
6806the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
6807operand.  If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
6808@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
6809@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
6810
6811@findex reg_names
6812If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
6813The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
6814@code{char *[]}.  @code{reg_names} is initialized from
6815@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
6816
6817When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
6818(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
6819with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
6820@var{code}.
6821
6822@findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
6823@item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
6824A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
6825punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro.  If
6826@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
6827punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
6828in this way.
6829
6830@findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
6831@item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
6832A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
6833assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
6834whose address is @var{x}.  @var{x} is an RTL expression.
6835
6836@cindex @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
6837On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
6838section that the address refers to.  On these machines, define the macro
6839@code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
6840@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here.  @xref{Assembler Format}.
6841
6842@findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
6843@findex dbr_sequence_length
6844@item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
6845A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
6846been output.  If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
6847determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
6848currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
6849or whatever.
6850
6851Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
6852reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
6853explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
6854
6855@findex final_sequence
6856Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
6857prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
6858(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
6859found.)  The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
6860processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
6861being output.
6862
6863@findex REGISTER_PREFIX
6864@findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6865@findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6866@findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6867@findex asm_fprintf
6868@item REGISTER_PREFIX
6869@itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
6870@itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
6871@itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
6872If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
6873@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
6874@file{final.c}).  These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
6875support multiple assembler formats.  In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
6876files can define these macros differently.
6877
6878@item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
6879@findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
6880If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
6881statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
6882the @code{asm_fprintf} function.  This allows targets to define extra
6883printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
6884statements.  Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
6885generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
6886specific code.  The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
6887The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
6888string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
6889upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
6890
6891@findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6892@item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
6893If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
6894different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
6895numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
6896first variant.
6897
6898If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
6899@smallexample
6900@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
6901@end smallexample
6902@noindent
6903in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
6904first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}.  This construct outputs
6905@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
6906@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc.  Any special characters
6907within these strings retain their usual meaning.  If there are fewer
6908alternatives within the braces than the value of
6909@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
6910
6911If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
6912@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
6913operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
6914
6915Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
6916@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
6917the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism.  Define
6918@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
6919if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
6920opcodes or operand order.
6921
6922@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
6923@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6924A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6925which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
6926The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6927profiling.
6928
6929@findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
6930@item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
6931A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
6932which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
6933The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
6934profiling.
6935@end table
6936
6937@node Dispatch Tables
6938@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
6939
6940@c prevent bad page break with this line
6941This concerns dispatch tables.
6942
6943@table @code
6944@cindex dispatch table
6945@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
6946@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
6947A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6948pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
6949@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels.  The
6950definitions of these labels are output using
6951@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}, and they must be printed in the same
6952way here.  For example,
6953
6954@example
6955fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
6956         @var{value}, @var{rel})
6957@end example
6958
6959You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
6960dispatch table are relative to the table's own address.  If defined, GCC
6961will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
6962@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
6963mode and flags can be read.
6964
6965@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
6966@item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
6967This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
6968in a dispatch table are absolute.
6969
6970The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
6971@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
6972a label.  @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
6973definition is output using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6974For example,
6975
6976@example
6977fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
6978@end example
6979
6980@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
6981@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6982Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
6983specially.  The first three arguments are the same as for
6984@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}; the fourth argument is the
6985jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
6986@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
6987
6988This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
6989for the table.
6990
6991If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
6992@code{ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
6993
6994@findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
6995@item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
6996Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
6997jump-table.  The definition should be a C statement to be executed
6998after the assembler code for the table is written.  It should write
6999the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}.  The argument
7000@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7001of the preceding label.
7002
7003If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7004the jump-table.
7005@end table
7006
7007@node Exception Region Output
7008@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7009
7010@c prevent bad page break with this line
7011
7012This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7013region.
7014
7015@table @code
7016@findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7017@item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7018If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7019exception handling frame unwind information.  If not defined, GCC will
7020provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7021@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7022
7023You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7024unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7025
7026@findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7027@item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7028If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7029data section even though the target supports named sections.  This
7030might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7031collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7032
7033Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7034also defined.
7035
7036@findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7037@item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7038An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7039that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7040
7041@findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7042@item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7043Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7044information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7045Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7046@samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7047or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
70481.
7049
7050If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7051exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7052default.
7053
7054If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7055instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7056
7057@findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7058@item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7059This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7060function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7061@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}.  The definition should be the negative minimum
7062alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7063minimum alignment otherwise.  @xref{SDB and DWARF}.  Only applicable if
7064the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7065
7066@end table
7067
7068@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7069If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7070exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default is a
7071function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7072machines that support named sections via
7073@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7074@option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7075@code{readonly_data_section}.
7076@end deftypefn
7077
7078@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7079If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7080frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}).  The default
7081is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7082@code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7083directive followed by a synthetic label.
7084@end deftypefn
7085
7086@node Alignment Output
7087@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7088
7089@c prevent bad page break with this line
7090This describes commands for alignment.
7091
7092@table @code
7093@findex JUMP_ALIGN
7094@item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7095The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7096a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7097
7098This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7099to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7100define the macro.
7101
7102Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7103to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7104@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7105selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7106
7107@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7108@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7109The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7110a @code{BARRIER}.
7111
7112This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7113to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7114define the macro.
7115
7116@findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7117@item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7118The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7119@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}.  This works only if
7120@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7121
7122@findex LOOP_ALIGN
7123@item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7124The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7125a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7126
7127This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7128to be done at such a time.  Most machine descriptions do not currently
7129define the macro.
7130
7131Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7132to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7133@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7134selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7135
7136@findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7137@item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7138The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7139This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7140
7141@findex LABEL_ALIGN
7142@item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7143The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7144If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7145the maximum of the specified values is used.
7146
7147Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7148to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7149@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.  Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7150selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7151
7152@findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7153@item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7154The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7155This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7156
7157@findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7158@item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7159A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7160instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7161Those bytes should be zero when loaded.  @var{nbytes} will be a C
7162expression of type @code{int}.
7163
7164@findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7165@item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7166Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7167text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7168This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7169produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7170section.
7171
7172@findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7173@item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7174A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7175command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7176@var{power} bytes.  @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7177
7178@findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7179@item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7180A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7181command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7182@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7183satisfy the alignment request.  @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7184a C expression of type @code{int}.
7185@end table
7186
7187@need 3000
7188@node Debugging Info
7189@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7190
7191@c prevent bad page break with this line
7192This describes how to specify debugging information.
7193
7194@menu
7195* All Debuggers::      Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7196* DBX Options::        Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7197* DBX Hooks::          Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7198* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7199* SDB and DWARF::      Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7200* VMS Debug::          Macros for VMS debug format.
7201@end menu
7202
7203@node All Debuggers
7204@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7205
7206@c prevent bad page break with this line
7207These macros affect all debugging formats.
7208
7209@table @code
7210@findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7211@item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7212A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7213register number @var{regno}.  In the default macro provided, the value
7214of this expression will be @var{regno} itself.  But sometimes there are
7215some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7216versa.  In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7217compiler and another for DBX@.
7218
7219If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7220used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7221consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7222Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7223expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7224
7225If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7226does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7227redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7228
7229@findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7230@item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7231A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7232variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The default
7233computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7234gives the offset from the frame-pointer.  This is required for targets
7235that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7236for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7237@option{-g} options is used.
7238
7239@findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7240@item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7241A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7242having address @var{x} (an RTL expression).  The nominal offset is
7243@var{offset}.
7244
7245@findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7246@item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7247A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7248produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}.  Define
7249this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7250debugging output.  Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7251@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7252@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7253
7254When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7255value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7256exceptions.  If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7257@code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7258value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}.  Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7259defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7260
7261The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7262user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7263@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7264or @option{-gvms}.
7265@end table
7266
7267@node DBX Options
7268@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7269
7270@c prevent bad page break with this line
7271These are specific options for DBX output.
7272
7273@table @code
7274@findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7275@item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7276Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7277in response to the @option{-g} option.
7278
7279@findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7280@item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7281Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7282in response to the @option{-g} option.  This is a variant of DBX format.
7283
7284@findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7285@item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7286Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7287GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7288debugging information is enabled at all).  If you don't define the
7289macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7290if there is any occasion to.
7291
7292@findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7293@item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7294Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7295in the text section.
7296
7297@findex ASM_STABS_OP
7298@item ASM_STABS_OP
7299A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7300use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7301If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used.  This macro
7302applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7303
7304@findex ASM_STABD_OP
7305@item ASM_STABD_OP
7306A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7307use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7308value is the current location.  If you don't define this macro,
7309@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used.  This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7310information format.
7311
7312@findex ASM_STABN_OP
7313@item ASM_STABN_OP
7314A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7315use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7316name.  If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used.  This
7317macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7318
7319@findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7320@item DBX_NO_XREFS
7321Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7322@samp{xs@var{tagname}}.  On some systems, this construct is used to
7323describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7324On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7325
7326@findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7327@item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7328A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7329continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7330exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters).  On some
7331operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7332must not be done.  You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7333with the value zero.  You can override the default splitting-length by
7334defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7335
7336@findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7337@item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7338Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7339the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows.  To use
7340a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7341constant for the character you want to use.  Do not define this macro
7342if backslash is correct for your system.
7343
7344@findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7345@item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7346Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7347outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7348variable.
7349
7350@findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7351@item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7352The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7353for a typedef.  The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7354
7355@findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7356@item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7357The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7358for a static variable located in the text section.  DBX format does not
7359provide any ``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7360
7361@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7362@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7363The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7364for a parameter passed in registers.  DBX format does not provide any
7365``right'' way to do this.  The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7366
7367@findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7368@item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7369The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7370passed in registers.  DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7371do this.  The default is @code{'P'}.
7372
7373@findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7374@item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7375The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7376parameter.  The default is @code{'p'}.
7377
7378@findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7379@item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7380Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7381arguments should precede the assembler code for the function.  Normally,
7382in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7383code.
7384
7385@findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7386@item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7387Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7388precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7389that block.  Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7390first.
7391
7392@findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7393@item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7394Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7395block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7396of the enclosing function.  Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7397
7398@findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7399@item DBX_USE_BINCL
7400Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7401@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems.  This
7402macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7403number and a type number within the file.  Normally, GCC does not
7404generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7405number for a type number.
7406@end table
7407
7408@node DBX Hooks
7409@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7410
7411@c prevent bad page break with this line
7412These are hooks for DBX format.
7413
7414@table @code
7415@findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7416@item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7417Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7418information for the start of a scope level for variable names.  The
7419argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7420@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7421
7422@findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7423@item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7424Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7425
7426@findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7427@item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7428Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7429output an enumeration type.  The definition should be a C statement
7430(sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7431for the type @var{type}.
7432
7433@findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7434@item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7435Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7436end of the debugging information for a function.  The definition should
7437be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7438to @var{stream}.  @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7439the function.
7440
7441@findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7442@item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7443Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7444standard data types at the beginning of compilation.  The argument
7445@var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7446global symbols, including names of data types.
7447
7448Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7449and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
7450particular language in no particular order.
7451
7452On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
7453first.  To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
7454those symbols in the necessary order.  Any predefined types that you
7455don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
7456
7457Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@.  There
7458are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
7459another language may have another set of types.  The way to output a
7460particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
7461Here is an example:
7462
7463@smallexample
7464@{
7465  tree decl;
7466  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7467    if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
7468                 "long int"))
7469      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7470  @dots{}
7471@}
7472@end smallexample
7473
7474@noindent
7475This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
7476
7477See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
7478the names to use for all the built-in C types.
7479
7480Here is another way of finding a particular type:
7481
7482@c this is still overfull.  --mew 10feb93
7483@smallexample
7484@{
7485  tree decl;
7486  for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
7487    if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
7488        && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
7489            == INTEGER_CST)
7490        && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
7491        && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
7492@group
7493      /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.}  */
7494      dbxout_symbol (decl);
7495  @dots{}
7496@}
7497@end group
7498@end smallexample
7499
7500@findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7501@item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
7502Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
7503@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
7504On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
7505disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
7506
7507@end table
7508
7509@node File Names and DBX
7510@subsection File Names in DBX Format
7511
7512@c prevent bad page break with this line
7513This describes file names in DBX format.
7514
7515@table @code
7516@findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7517@item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
7518Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
7519object file.
7520
7521Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
7522enabled.
7523
7524@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
7525@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7526A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7527@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
7528file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
7529This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
7530
7531This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7532for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7533
7534@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
7535@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7536A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7537@var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
7538compilation is named @var{name}.
7539
7540This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7541for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7542
7543@findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
7544@item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7545A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
7546compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
7547
7548If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
7549of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
7550
7551@findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7552@item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7553A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
7554@var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
7555file.  This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
7556source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
7557or a @samp{#line} command.
7558
7559This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7560for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
7561@end table
7562
7563@need 2000
7564@node SDB and DWARF
7565@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
7566
7567@c prevent bad page break with this line
7568Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
7569
7570@table @code
7571@findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7572@item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
7573Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
7574for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
7575
7576@findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7577@item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7578Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
7579in response to the @option{-g} option.
7580
7581@findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7582@item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
7583Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
7584debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
7585
7586To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
7587define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
7588@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
7589prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
7590as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
7591
7592@findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7593@item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
7594Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
7595Dwarf 2 frame information.  If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
7596(@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
7597information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
7598
7599@findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7600@item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
7601Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
7602Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
7603version 2 if available; this macro disables this.  See the description
7604of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
7605
7606@findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7607@item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
7608By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
7609label to mark the beginning of the text section.  If it is better simply
7610to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
7611to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
7612
7613@findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7614@item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
7615Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
7616line debug info sections.  This will result in much more compact line number
7617tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
7618
7619@findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7620@item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
7621Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
7622SDB assembler directives.  See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
7623macros and their arguments.  If the standard syntax is used, you need
7624not define them yourself.
7625
7626@findex SDB_DELIM
7627@item SDB_DELIM
7628Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
7629SDB assembler directives.  In that case, define this macro to be the
7630delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}).  It is not necessary to define
7631a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
7632required.
7633
7634@findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7635@item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
7636Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
7637name for anonymous structure and union types.  See @file{sdbout.c} for
7638more information.
7639
7640@findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7641@item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
7642Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
7643union, or enumeration tags to be emitted.  Standard COFF does not
7644allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
7645it.
7646
7647@findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7648@item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
7649Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
7650enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled.  Some
7651assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
7652@end table
7653
7654@need 2000
7655@node VMS Debug
7656@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
7657
7658@c prevent bad page break with this line
7659Here are macros for VMS debug format.
7660
7661@table @code
7662@findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7663@item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7664Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
7665in response to the @option{-g} option.  The default behavior for VMS
7666is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
7667@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}.  This
7668behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
7669@code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
7670@end table
7671
7672@node Cross-compilation
7673@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
7674@cindex cross compilation and floating point
7675@cindex floating point and cross compilation
7676
7677While all modern machines use 2's complement representation for integers,
7678there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers.  This
7679means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
7680in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
7681doing the compilation.
7682
7683@findex atof
7684Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
7685range and precision, the cross compiler cannot safely use the host
7686machine's floating point arithmetic.  Therefore, floating point constants
7687must be represented in the target machine's format.  This means that the
7688cross compiler cannot use @code{atof} to parse a floating point constant;
7689it must have its own special routine to use instead.  Also, constant
7690folding must emulate the target machine's arithmetic (or must not be done
7691at all).
7692
7693The macros in the following table should be defined only if you are cross
7694compiling between different floating point formats.
7695
7696Otherwise, don't define them.  Then default definitions will be set up which
7697use @code{double} as the data type, @code{==} to test for equality, etc.
7698
7699You don't need to worry about how many times you use an operand of any
7700of these macros.  The compiler never uses operands which have side effects.
7701
7702@table @code
7703@findex REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7704@item REAL_VALUE_TYPE
7705A macro for the C data type to be used to hold a floating point value
7706in the target machine's format.  Typically this would be a
7707@code{struct} containing an array of @code{int}.
7708
7709@findex REAL_VALUES_EQUAL
7710@item REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (@var{x}, @var{y})
7711A macro for a C expression which compares for equality the two values,
7712@var{x} and @var{y}, both of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7713
7714@findex REAL_VALUES_LESS
7715@item REAL_VALUES_LESS (@var{x}, @var{y})
7716A macro for a C expression which tests whether @var{x} is less than
7717@var{y}, both values being of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and
7718interpreted as floating point numbers in the target machine's
7719representation.
7720
7721@findex REAL_VALUE_LDEXP
7722@findex ldexp
7723@item REAL_VALUE_LDEXP (@var{x}, @var{scale})
7724A macro for a C expression which performs the standard library
7725function @code{ldexp}, but using the target machine's floating point
7726representation.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression have
7727type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.  The second argument, @var{scale}, is an
7728integer.
7729
7730@findex REAL_VALUE_FIX
7731@item REAL_VALUE_FIX (@var{x})
7732A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7733floating point value @var{x} to a signed integer.  @var{x} has type
7734@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7735
7736@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX
7737@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (@var{x})
7738A macro whose definition is a C expression to convert the target-machine
7739floating point value @var{x} to an unsigned integer.  @var{x} has type
7740@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7741
7742@findex REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT
7743@item REAL_VALUE_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7744A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7745floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an integer value (but still
7746as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE},
7747and so does the value.
7748
7749@findex REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT
7750@item REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_RNDZINT (@var{x})
7751A macro whose definition is a C expression to round the target-machine
7752floating point value @var{x} towards zero to an unsigned integer value
7753(but still represented as a floating point number).  @var{x} has type
7754@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, and so does the value.
7755
7756@findex REAL_VALUE_ATOF
7757@item REAL_VALUE_ATOF (@var{string}, @var{mode})
7758A macro for a C expression which converts @var{string}, an expression of
7759type @code{char *}, into a floating point number in the target machine's
7760representation for mode @var{mode}.  The value has type
7761@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7762
7763@findex REAL_INFINITY
7764@item REAL_INFINITY
7765Define this macro if infinity is a possible floating point value, and
7766therefore division by 0 is legitimate.
7767
7768@findex REAL_VALUE_ISINF
7769@findex isinf
7770@item REAL_VALUE_ISINF (@var{x})
7771A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7772point value, is infinity.  The value has type @code{int}.
7773By default, this is defined to call @code{isinf}.
7774
7775@findex REAL_VALUE_ISNAN
7776@findex isnan
7777@item REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (@var{x})
7778A macro for a C expression which determines whether @var{x}, a floating
7779point value, is a ``nan'' (not-a-number).  The value has type
7780@code{int}.  By default, this is defined to call @code{isnan}.
7781@end table
7782
7783@cindex constant folding and floating point
7784Define the following additional macros if you want to make floating
7785point constant folding work while cross compiling.  If you don't
7786define them, cross compilation is still possible, but constant folding
7787will not happen for floating point values.
7788
7789@table @code
7790@findex REAL_ARITHMETIC
7791@item REAL_ARITHMETIC (@var{output}, @var{code}, @var{x}, @var{y})
7792A macro for a C statement which calculates an arithmetic operation of
7793the two floating point values @var{x} and @var{y}, both of type
7794@code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} in the target machine's representation, to
7795produce a result of the same type and representation which is stored
7796in @var{output} (which will be a variable).
7797
7798The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}, a tree code
7799which will always be one of the following: @code{PLUS_EXPR},
7800@code{MINUS_EXPR}, @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR},
7801@code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
7802
7803@cindex overflow while constant folding
7804The expansion of this macro is responsible for checking for overflow.
7805If overflow happens, the macro expansion should execute the statement
7806@code{return 0;}, which indicates the inability to perform the
7807arithmetic operation requested.
7808
7809@findex REAL_VALUE_NEGATE
7810@item REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (@var{x})
7811A macro for a C expression which returns the negative of the floating
7812point value @var{x}.  Both @var{x} and the value of the expression
7813have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} and are in the target machine's
7814floating point representation.
7815
7816There is no way for this macro to report overflow, since overflow
7817can't happen in the negation operation.
7818
7819@findex REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE
7820@item REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (@var{mode}, @var{x})
7821A macro for a C expression which converts the floating point value
7822@var{x} to mode @var{mode}.
7823
7824Both @var{x} and the value of the expression are in the target machine's
7825floating point representation and have type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7826However, the value should have an appropriate bit pattern to be output
7827properly as a floating constant whose precision accords with mode
7828@var{mode}.
7829
7830There is no way for this macro to report overflow.
7831
7832@findex REAL_VALUE_TO_INT
7833@item REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (@var{low}, @var{high}, @var{x})
7834A macro for a C expression which converts a floating point value
7835@var{x} into a double-precision integer which is then stored into
7836@var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int}.
7837
7838@item REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (@var{x}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{mode})
7839@findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
7840A macro for a C expression which converts a double-precision integer
7841found in @var{low} and @var{high}, two variables of type @var{int},
7842into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}.
7843The value is in the target machine's representation for mode @var{mode}
7844and has the type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}.
7845@end table
7846
7847@node Mode Switching
7848@section Mode Switching Instructions
7849@cindex mode switching
7850The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
7851
7852@table @code
7853@findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
7854@item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
7855Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
7856switching in an optimizing compilation.
7857
7858For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
7859floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
7860the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
7861operation, this bit has to be set.  Changing the PR bit requires a general
7862purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
7863be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
7864or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
7865
7866You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
7867which entities actually need it.  @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7868return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
7869If you define this macro, you also have to define
7870@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
7871@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
7872@code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
7873
7874@findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7875@item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
7876If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
7877initializer for an array of integers.  Each initializer element
7878N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
7879of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
7880The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
7881zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
7882entity in question.
7883In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
7884represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1.  N is used to specify that no mode
7885switch is needed / supplied.
7886
7887@findex MODE_NEEDED
7888@item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
7889@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity.  If
7890@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
7891return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
7892@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
7893be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
7894
7895@findex NORMAL_MODE
7896@item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
7897If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
7898mode switching.  It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
7899@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
7900
7901@findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
7902@item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
7903This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
79040 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
7905lowest.  The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
7906for @var{entity}.  For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
7907(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
7908@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
7909
7910@findex EMIT_MODE_SET
7911@item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
7912Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
7913@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
7914the insn(s) are to be inserted.
7915@end table
7916
7917@node Target Attributes
7918@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
7919@cindex target attributes
7920@cindex machine attributes
7921@cindex attributes, target-specific
7922
7923Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
7924These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
7925be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
7926
7927@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
7928If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
7929attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
7930specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
7931entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
7932take.
7933@end deftypevr
7934
7935@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7936If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
7937@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
7938and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
7939generated).  If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
7940supposed always to be compatible.
7941@end deftypefn
7942
7943@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
7944If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
7945newly defined @var{type}.
7946@end deftypefn
7947
7948@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
7949Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
7950handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7951@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}.  It is assumed
7952that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1.  This
7953function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
7954merging.
7955@end deftypefn
7956
7957@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
7958Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
7959handling.  If defined, the result is a list of the combined
7960@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
7961@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}.  Examples of
7962when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
7963attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition.  This function may
7964call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
7965
7966@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
7967If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
7968Windows targets, you should define the macro
7969@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This links in a function
7970called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
7971as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.  This is done
7972in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
7973@end deftypefn
7974
7975@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
7976Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
7977when it is being created.  This is normally useful for back ends which
7978wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
7979the pragma's effect.  The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
7980created.  The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
7981for this decl.  The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
7982shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
7983the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
7984attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
7985needed.
7986@end deftypefn
7987
7988@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
7989@cindex inlining
7990This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
7991into the current function, despite its having target-specific
7992attributes, @code{false} otherwise.  By default, if a function has a
7993target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
7994@end deftypefn
7995
7996@node Misc
7997@section Miscellaneous Parameters
7998@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
7999
8000@c prevent bad page break with this line
8001Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8002
8003@table @code
8004@item PREDICATE_CODES
8005@findex PREDICATE_CODES
8006Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
8007@file{@var{machine}.c}.  This macro is called within an initializer of an
8008array of structures.  The first field in the structure is the name of a
8009predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes.  For each
8010predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
8011predicate.  The list should have a trailing comma.  Here is an example
8012of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
8013
8014@smallexample
8015#define PREDICATE_CODES \
8016  @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@},  \
8017  @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
8018@end smallexample
8019
8020Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
8021incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
8022predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction).  Instead, it allows
8023the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
8024thus speeding up the compiler.  The most important predicates to include
8025in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
8026patterns.
8027
8028For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
8029declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
8030
8031@item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8032@findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8033Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
8034about modes.  Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
8035@code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
8036listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
8037suppressed.
8038
8039Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
8040specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
8041for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
8042
8043@smallexample
8044#define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
8045  "ext_register_operand",
8046@end smallexample
8047
8048@findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8049@item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8050An alias for a machine mode name.  This is the machine mode that
8051elements of a jump-table should have.
8052
8053@findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8054@item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8055Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8056when the minimum and maximum offset are known.  If you define this,
8057it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8058To make this work, you also have to define INSN_ALIGN and
8059make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8060The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8061flags can be updated.
8062
8063@findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8064@item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8065Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8066should contain relative addresses.  If jump-tables never contain
8067relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8068
8069@findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8070@item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8071Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8072value is out of range.  This means the specified default-label is
8073actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8074
8075@findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8076@item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8077Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8078is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8079The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8080five otherwise.  This is best for most machines.
8081
8082@findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8083@item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8084Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8085smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8086Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8087
8088@findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8089@item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8090Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8091memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8092bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8093zero-extension of the data read.  Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8094of @var{mode} for which the
8095insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8096@code{NIL} for other modes.
8097
8098This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8099greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8100value in this case.  Do not define this macro if it would always return
8101@code{NIL}.  On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8102define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8103
8104@findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8105@item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8106Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8107extends.
8108
8109@findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8110@item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8111Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8112point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8113unsigned one.
8114
8115@findex MOVE_MAX
8116@item MOVE_MAX
8117The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8118between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8119
8120@findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8121@item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8122The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8123between memory and registers or between two memory locations.  If this
8124is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}.  Otherwise, it is the
8125constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8126at run-time.
8127
8128@findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8129@item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8130A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8131actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8132of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted.  When
8133this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8134a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8135truncates the count of a shift operation.  On machines that have
8136instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8137include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8138also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8139arguments to bit-field instructions.
8140
8141If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8142position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8143instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8144
8145However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8146only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8147bit-field operations.  Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8148such machines.  Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8149the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8150
8151You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8152
8153@findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8154@item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8155A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8156``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8157bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8158operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8159
8160On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8161
8162@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that".  this was
8163@c to fix an overfull hbox.  --mew 10feb93
8164When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8165modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8166If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8167such cases may improve things.
8168
8169@findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8170@item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8171A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8172with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8173(@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true.  This description must
8174apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8175comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8176
8177A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8178comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8179and 0 when the comparison is false.  Otherwise, the value indicates
8180which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8181true.  This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8182operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8183@samp{s@var{cond}} pattern.  Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8184@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on.  Presently, only those bits are used by
8185the compiler.
8186
8187If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8188generate code that depends only on the specified bits.  It can also
8189replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8190the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8191For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8192@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8193@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8194expression
8195
8196@smallexample
8197(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8198@end smallexample
8199
8200@noindent
8201can be converted to
8202
8203@smallexample
8204(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8205@end smallexample
8206
8207@noindent
8208where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8209tested into the sign bit.
8210
8211There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8212for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8213but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction.  If you
8214are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8215perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8216comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8217
8218Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8219from a comparison (or the condition codes).  Here are rules to guide the
8220choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8221to be used:
8222
8223@itemize @bullet
8224@item
8225Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8226@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}.  It is more efficient for the compiler to
8227``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8228comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8229combine the normalization with other operations.
8230
8231@item
8232For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8233slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8234other machines.
8235
8236@item
8237As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8238exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8239others.
8240
8241@item
8242Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8243@end itemize
8244
8245Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8246@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8247instructions.  On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8248those cases, e.g., one matching
8249
8250@smallexample
8251(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8252@end smallexample
8253
8254Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8255condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8256@samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}.  On those
8257machines, define the appropriate patterns.  Use the names @code{incscc}
8258and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8259@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values.  See
8260@file{rs6000.md} for some examples.  The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8261find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8262
8263You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8264instructions.
8265
8266@findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8267@item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8268A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8269returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8270Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8271floating-point values.  If there are no such operations, do not define
8272this macro.
8273
8274@findex Pmode
8275@item Pmode
8276An alias for the machine mode for pointers.  On most machines, define
8277this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8278pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8279On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8280modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8281
8282The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8283@code{POINTER_SIZE}.  If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8284@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8285to @code{Pmode}.
8286
8287@findex FUNCTION_MODE
8288@item FUNCTION_MODE
8289An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8290being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions.  On most machines this
8291should be @code{QImode}.
8292
8293@findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8294@item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8295A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8296function @var{decl} should not be inlined.  @var{decl} is a
8297@code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8298
8299The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8300arguments that the function accepts.  Some people think a larger
8301threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8302
8303@findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8304@item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8305In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8306constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@.  On some
8307hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8308where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8309strict conformance to the C Standard.
8310
8311Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8312convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8313files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8314
8315@findex SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8316@item SCCS_DIRECTIVE
8317Define this if the preprocessor should ignore @code{#sccs} directives
8318and print no error message.
8319
8320@findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8321@item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8322Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8323This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8324C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8325@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8326
8327@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8328@item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8329This macro is no longer supported.  You must use
8330@code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8331
8332@findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8333@findex #pragma
8334@findex pragma
8335@item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS (@var{pfile})
8336Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8337If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8338@code{cpp_register_pragma} for each pragma, with @var{pfile} passed as
8339the first argument to to these functions.  The macro may also do any
8340setup required for the pragmas.
8341
8342The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8343other compilers for the same target.  In general, we discourage
8344definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8345
8346If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8347defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8348
8349Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded.  All
8350@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8351silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8352
8353@deftypefun void cpp_register_pragma (cpp_reader *@var{pfile}, const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (cpp_reader *))
8354
8355Each call to @code{cpp_register_pragma} establishes one pragma.  The
8356@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8357pragma of the form
8358
8359@smallexample
8360#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8361@end smallexample
8362
8363@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8364@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace.  The callback
8365routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8366on to cpplib's functions if necessary.  You can lex tokens after the
8367@var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}.  Tokens that are not read by the
8368callback will be silently ignored.  The end of the line is indicated by
8369a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8370
8371For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8372routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8373
8374Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8375compilers.  It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8376other language compilers for that matter.  Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8377to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8378building the C and C++ compilers.  This can be done by defining the
8379variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8380target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file.  These variables should name
8381the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8382code that uses @code{c_lex}.  Note it will also be necessary to add a
8383rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8384how to build this object file.
8385@end deftypefun
8386
8387@findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8388@findex #pragma
8389@findex pragma
8390@item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8391Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8392pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8393[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8394
8395The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8396within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8397@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A pack value of zero resets
8398the behavior to the default.
8399
8400The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8401@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined.  If enabled it allows the creation
8402of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8403
8404@findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8405@findex #pragma
8406@findex pragma
8407@item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8408Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8409style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8410pack(pop)}.  The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8411(in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8412@samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do.  A
8413pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default.  Successive
8414invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8415that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8416value.
8417
8418@findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8419@item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
8420Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
8421names.  0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
84221 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
8423This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
8424
8425@findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8426@item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8427Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8428@samp{$} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in
8429G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers.  If this macro is defined,
8430@samp{.} is used instead.
8431
8432@findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8433@item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8434Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8435@samp{.} in label names.  By default constructors and destructors in G++
8436have names that use @samp{.}.  If this macro is defined, these names
8437are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8438
8439@findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8440@item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
8441Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
8442function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
8443value is explicitly returned).
8444
8445The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
8446appropriate rtl instructions.  It is used only when compiling the end of
8447@code{main}.
8448
8449@item NEED_ATEXIT
8450@findex NEED_ATEXIT
8451Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
8452from the ISO C standard.  If this macro is defined, a default definition
8453will be provided to support C++.  If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
8454a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
8455
8456@item ON_EXIT
8457@findex ON_EXIT
8458Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
8459functionality without replacing @code{exit}.  For instance, SunOS 4 has
8460a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
8461
8462The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
8463the @code{atexit} function.
8464
8465@item EXIT_BODY
8466@findex EXIT_BODY
8467Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
8468besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
8469terminating with @code{_exit}.  The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
8470only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
8471defined.
8472
8473@findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
8474@item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8475Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8476delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8477even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
8478@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
8479every @code{call_insn} has this behavior.  On machines where some @code{insn}
8480or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
8481you should define this macro.
8482
8483You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8484
8485@findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
8486@item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
8487Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
8488delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
8489even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
8490@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}.  On machines where
8491some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
8492are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
8493define this macro.  Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
8494instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
8495slot of @var{insn}.
8496
8497You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
8498
8499@findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
8500@item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
8501In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
8502dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
8503delayed branch scheduling.  On those machines, define this macro as a C
8504statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
8505
8506@findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8507@item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
8508Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
8509unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
8510without user intervention.  For instance, under Microsoft Windows
8511symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
8512
8513@findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
8514@item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
8515A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
8516any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
8517
8518@findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8519@item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
8520Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
8521operations other than load, store and copy operations.
8522
8523You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
8524@code{word_mode} in general purpose registers.  Most targets should not define
8525this macro.
8526
8527@findex MATH_LIBRARY
8528@item MATH_LIBRARY
8529Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
8530in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
8531separate math library.
8532
8533You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
8534
8535@findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8536@item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
8537Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
8538specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
8539
8540You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
8541is wrong.
8542
8543@findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8544@item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
8545Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
8546Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
8547Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
8548to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
8549if the program has forked.
8550
8551@findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8552@item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
8553
8554A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
8555conditional execution instructions instead of a branch.  A value of
8556@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
85571 if it does use cc0.
8558
8559@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8560@item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
8561A C expression to modify the tests in @code{TRUE_EXPR}, and
8562@code{FALSE_EXPR} for use in converting insns in @code{TEST_BB},
8563@code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB} basic blocks to
8564conditional execution.  Set either @code{TRUE_EXPR} or @code{FALSE_EXPR}
8565to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
8566
8567@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8568@item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
8569A C expression to modify the @code{PATTERN} of an @code{INSN} that is to
8570be converted to conditional execution format.
8571
8572@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8573@item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
8574A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
8575converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8576@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8577
8578@findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8579@item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
8580A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
8581converting code to conditional execution in the basic blocks
8582@code{TEST_BB}, @code{THEN_BB}, @code{ELSE_BB}, and @code{JOIN_BB}.
8583@end table
8584
8585@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
8586Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
8587that need to be defined.  It should be a function that performs the
8588necessary setup.
8589
8590Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
8591instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
8592they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
8593instructions or prefetch instructions).
8594
8595To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
8596which is defined by the language front end.  You can use any type nodes set
8597up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
8598only language front ends that use those two functions will call
8599@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
8600@end deftypefn
8601
8602@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
8603
8604Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
8605@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.  @var{exp} is the expression for the
8606function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
8607convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
8608@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
8609@var{exp}'s operands.  @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
8610ignored.  This function should return the result of the call to the
8611built-in function.
8612@end deftypefn
8613
8614@table @code
8615@findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
8616@item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
8617
8618Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
8619Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
8620@var{branch2} is possible.
8621
8622On some targets, branches may have a limited range.  Optimizing the
8623filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
8624may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
8625
8626@findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
8627@item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
8628
8629When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
8630register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
8631to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
8632it has been saved into can be used.  @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
8633defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
8634hard register that had its initial value copied by using
8635@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
8636Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
8637to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
8638the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
8639@code{MEM}.
8640If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
8641it might decide to use another register anyways.
8642You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
8643macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
8644register in question will not be clobbered.
8645
8646@findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8647@item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
8648Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
8649files on your target machine.  If you do not define this macro, GCC will
8650use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
8651
8652@findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8653@item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
8654Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
8655automatically added to executable files on your target machine.  If you
8656do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
8657executable files.
8658
8659@findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8660@item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
8661If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
8662specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
8663Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
8664object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
8665lists.
8666
8667@end table
8668
8669@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
8670This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
8671instructions could be created.  On machines that require a register for
8672every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
8673reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
8674
8675@smallexample
8676static bool
8677cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
8678@{
8679  return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
8680@}
8681@end smallexample
8682@end deftypefn
8683